blob: 65df4172b9235e7a274b0f984c16d49815bc27d4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1a34d572014-02-03 00:41:29 +01007 2014/02/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100158By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
160leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
161start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100163HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
164 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
165 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
166 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
167 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
168 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
169 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
1721.2. HTTP request
173-----------------
174
175First, let's consider this HTTP request :
176
177 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100178 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
180 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
181 3 User-agent: my small browser
182 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
183 5 Accept: image/png
184
185
1861.2.1. The Request line
187-----------------------
188
189Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
190
191 - a METHOD : GET
192 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
193 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
194
195All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
196which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
197followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
198is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
199desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
200the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
201
202The URI itself can have several forms :
203
204 - A "relative URI" :
205
206 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
209 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
210
211 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
212
213 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
216 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
217 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
218 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
219 must accept this form too.
220
221 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
222 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
223 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
226 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
227 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
228 other protocols too.
229
230In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
231mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
232on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
233It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
234specific to the language, framework or application in use.
235
236
2371.2.2. The request headers
238--------------------------
239
240The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
241beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
242an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
243Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
244values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
245encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
246the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
247define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
248
249Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
250their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
251"Connection:" header).
252
253The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
254that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
255is one valid form of empty line.
256
257Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
258headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
259about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
260application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
261
262Important note:
263 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
264 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
265 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
266 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
267
268
2691.3. HTTP response
270------------------
271
272An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
273messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
274
275 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100276 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200277 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
278 2 Content-length: 350
279 3 Content-Type: text/html
280
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200281As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
282codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
283response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100284continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
285the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
286following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
287sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
288(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
289correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
290such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
291state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
292over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
293if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
294information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
2971.3.1. The Response line
298------------------------
299
300Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
301
302 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
303 - a status code : 200
304 - a reason : OK
305
306The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200307 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
309 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
310 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
311 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
312
313Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100314"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
316messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
317or "Authentication Required".
318
319Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
320
321 Code When / reason
322 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
323 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
324 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100326 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328 400 for an invalid or too large request
329 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
330 accessing the stats page)
331 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
332 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
333 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
334 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
335 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
336 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
337 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
338 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
339 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
340
341The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3424.2).
343
344
3451.3.2. The response headers
346---------------------------
347
348Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
349the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
350details.
351
352
3532. Configuring HAProxy
354----------------------
355
3562.1. Configuration file format
357------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200358
359HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
360
361 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
362 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
363 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
364 "frontend" and "backend".
365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
367referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
368delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100369preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100370escaped by doubling them.
371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372
3732.2. Time format
374----------------
375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100376Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
378otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
379numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
380for every keyword. Supported units are :
381
382 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
383 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
384 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
385 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
386 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
387 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
388
389
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003902.3. Examples
391-------------
392
393 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
394 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
395 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
396 global
397 daemon
398 maxconn 256
399
400 defaults
401 mode http
402 timeout connect 5000ms
403 timeout client 50000ms
404 timeout server 50000ms
405
406 frontend http-in
407 bind *:80
408 default_backend servers
409
410 backend servers
411 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
412
413
414 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
415 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
416 global
417 daemon
418 maxconn 256
419
420 defaults
421 mode http
422 timeout connect 5000ms
423 timeout client 50000ms
424 timeout server 50000ms
425
426 listen http-in
427 bind *:80
428 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
429
430
431Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
432
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100433 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200434
435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200437--------------------
438
439Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
440are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
441of them have command-line equivalents.
442
443The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
444
445 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200448 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 - daemon
450 - gid
451 - group
452 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100453 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - nbproc
455 - pidfile
456 - uid
457 - ulimit-n
458 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200459 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100460 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200461 - node
462 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100463 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100464
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200465 * Performance tuning
466 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200467 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100468 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100469 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100470 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200471 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200472 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200473 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 - noepoll
475 - nokqueue
476 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100477 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300478 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200479 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200480 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200481 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100482 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100483 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200484 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100485 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100486 - tune.maxaccept
487 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200488 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200489 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100490 - tune.rcvbuf.client
491 - tune.rcvbuf.server
492 - tune.sndbuf.client
493 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100494 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100495 - tune.ssl.lifetime
496 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100497 - tune.zlib.memlevel
498 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 * Debugging
501 - debug
502 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503
504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005053.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506------------------------------------
507
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200508ca-base <dir>
509 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200510 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
511 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200513chroot <jail dir>
514 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
515 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
516 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
517 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
518 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
519 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100520
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100521cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
522 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
523 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
524 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
525 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
526 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
527 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
528 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
529 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
530 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
531 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
532 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
533 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
534 they overlap.
535
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200536crt-base <dir>
537 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
538 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
539 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541daemon
542 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
543 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
544 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
545
546gid <number>
547 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
548 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
549 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100550 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
551 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554group <group name>
555 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
556 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200558log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
560 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100561 configured with "log global".
562
563 <address> can be one of:
564
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100565 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
567 port).
568
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100569 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100573 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
574 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
575 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
576 writeable).
577
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100578 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
579 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
580 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
581 in Bourne shell.
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584
585 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
586 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
587 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
588
589 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200590 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
591 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
592 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
593 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
594 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
595 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200597 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100599log-send-hostname [<string>]
600 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
601 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
602 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
603 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
604 the logs.
605
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000606log-tag <string>
607 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
608 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
609 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
610 running on the same host.
611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612nbproc <number>
613 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
614 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
615 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
616 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
617 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
618
619pidfile <pidfile>
620 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
621 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
622 starting the process. See also "daemon".
623
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100624stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200625 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
626 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
627 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
628 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
629 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
630 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
631 the number of processes used.
632
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100633ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
635 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300636 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100637 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
638 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
639 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
640 "bind" keyword for more information.
641
642ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
644 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300645 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100646 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
647 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
648 information.
649
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100650ssl-server-verify [none|required]
651 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
652 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
653 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
654
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200655stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
656 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
657 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
658 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
659 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200660
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200661 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
662 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
663 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200664
665stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
666 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
667 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100668 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200669
670stats maxconn <connections>
671 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
672 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674uid <number>
675 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
676 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
677 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
678 one. See also "gid" and "user".
679
680ulimit-n <number>
681 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
682 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
683 option.
684
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100685unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
686 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
687
688 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
689 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
690 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
691 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
692 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
693 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
694 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
695 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
696 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
697 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699user <user name>
700 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
701 See also "uid" and "group".
702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200703node <name>
704 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
705
706 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
707 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
708 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
709 traffic.
710
711description <text>
712 Add a text that describes the instance.
713
714 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
715 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
716 "<" and ">" characters.
717
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720-----------------------
721
722maxconn <number>
723 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
724 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
725 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
726 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
727
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200728maxconnrate <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
730 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
731 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
732 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
733 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
734 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
735 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
736 fairness.
737
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100738maxcomprate <number>
739 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300740 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100741 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
742 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
743 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
744 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
745 default value.
746
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100747maxcompcpuusage <number>
748 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
749 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
750 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
751 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
752 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
753 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
754 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
755 process down and from introducing high latencies.
756
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100757maxpipes <number>
758 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
759 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
760 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
761 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
762 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
763 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
764
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200765maxsessrate <number>
766 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
767 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
768 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
769 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
770 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
771 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
772 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
773 fairness.
774
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200775maxsslconn <number>
776 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
777 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
778 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
779 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
780 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
781 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
782 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
783
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200784maxsslrate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
786 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
787 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
788 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
789 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
790 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
791 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
792 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
793 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
794 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
795
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100796maxzlibmem <number>
797 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
798 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
799 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100800 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
801 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
802 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804noepoll
805 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
806 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100807 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
809nokqueue
810 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
811 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
812 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
813
814nopoll
815 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
816 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100817 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100818 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100820nosplice
821 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
822 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
823 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100824 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100825 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
826 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
827 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
828 "option splice-response".
829
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300830nogetaddrinfo
831 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
832 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
833
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200834spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900835 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
836 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
837 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
838 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
839 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
840 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200841
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200842tune.bufsize <number>
843 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
844 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
845 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
846 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
847 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
848 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
849 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
850 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400851 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
852 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
853 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200854
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200855tune.chksize <number>
856 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
857 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
858 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
859 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
860 checks whenever possible.
861
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100862tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
863 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
864 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
865 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
866 this value. The default value is 1.
867
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100868tune.http.cookielen <number>
869 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
870 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
871 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
872 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
873 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
874 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
875 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
876 to change this value.
877
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200878tune.http.maxhdr <number>
879 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
880 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
881 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
882 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
883 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
884 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
885 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
886 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
887 limit too high.
888
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100889tune.idletimer <timeout>
890 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
891 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
892 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
893 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
894 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
895 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
896 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
897 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
898 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
899
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100900tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100901 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
902 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
903 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
904 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
905 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
906 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
907 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
908 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
909 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
910 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100911
912tune.maxpollevents <number>
913 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
914 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
915 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
916 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
917 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
918
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200919tune.maxrewrite <number>
920 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
921 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
922 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
923 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
924 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
925 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
926 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
927 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
928 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
929 bufsize.
930
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200931tune.pipesize <number>
932 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
933 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
934 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
935 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
936 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
937 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
938
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100939tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
940tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
941 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
942 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
943 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
944 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
945 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
946 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
947 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
948
949tune.sndbuf.client <number>
950tune.sndbuf.server <number>
951 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
952 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
953 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
954 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
955 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
956 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
957 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
958 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
959 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
960 notifying haproxy again.
961
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100962tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100963 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
964 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
965 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300966 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100967 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
968 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
969 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
970 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
971 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100972 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
973 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100974
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100975tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
976 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300977 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100978 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
979 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
980 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
981 being used for too long.
982
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100983tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
984 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
985 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
986 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
987 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
988 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
989 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
990 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
991 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
992 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
993 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100994 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
995 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100996
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100997tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
998 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300999 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001000 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1001 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1002 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1003
1004tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1005 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1006 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1007 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1008 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010103.3. Debugging
1011--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001012
1013debug
1014 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1015 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1016 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1017 system startup.
1018
1019quiet
1020 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1021 line argument "-q".
1022
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010243.4. Userlists
1025--------------
1026It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1027http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1028it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1029
1030userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001031 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001032 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1033
1034group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001035 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001036 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1037 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1038
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001039user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1040 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001041 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1042 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001043 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1044 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001045 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001046 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001047
1048
1049 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001050 userlist L1
1051 group G1 users tiger,scott
1052 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001053
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001054 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1055 user scott insecure-password elgato
1056 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001057
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001058 userlist L2
1059 group G1
1060 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1063 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1064 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001065
1066 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001068
10693.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001070----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001071It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1072haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1073pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1074identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1075or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1076Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1077known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1078the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1079process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1080during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1081tables.
1082
1083peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001084 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001085 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1086
1087peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1088 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1089 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1090 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1091 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1092 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1093 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1094
1095 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1096 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1097
1098 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1099 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1100 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1101 across all peers.
1102
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001103 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1104 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1105 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1106
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001107 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001108 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001109 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1110 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1111 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001112
1113 backend mybackend
1114 mode tcp
1115 balance roundrobin
1116 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1117 stick on src
1118
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001119 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1120 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001121
1122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001125
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1127 - defaults <name>
1128 - frontend <name>
1129 - backend <name>
1130 - listen <name>
1131
1132A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1133its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1134section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001135section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
1137A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1138connections.
1139
1140A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1141to forward incoming connections.
1142
1143A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1144parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1147'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1148case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1149
1150Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1151logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1152proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1153However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1154name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1155
1156Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1157and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001158bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001159protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1160modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1161arbitrary criteria.
1162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001163In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1164a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1165the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1166
1167 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1168 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1169 between responses and new requests.
1170
1171 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1172 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1174 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1175
1176 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1177 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1178 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1179
1180 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1181 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1182 client-facing connection remains open.
1183
1184 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1185 after the end of the response.
1186
1187The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1188frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1189following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1190weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1191
1192 Backend mode
1193
1194 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1195 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1196 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1197 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1198 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1199 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1200 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1201 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1202 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1203 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1204 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1209--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001211The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1212limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1213they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1214limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001215marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001216option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001217and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1218with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1219specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001221
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001222 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1223------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1224acl - X X X
1225appsession - - X X
1226backlog X X X -
1227balance X - X X
1228bind - X X -
1229bind-process X X X X
1230block - X X X
1231capture cookie - X X -
1232capture request header - X X -
1233capture response header - X X -
1234clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001235compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001236contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1237cookie X - X X
1238default-server X - X X
1239default_backend X X X -
1240description - X X X
1241disabled X X X X
1242dispatch - - X X
1243enabled X X X X
1244errorfile X X X X
1245errorloc X X X X
1246errorloc302 X X X X
1247-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1248errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001249force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250fullconn X - X X
1251grace X X X X
1252hash-type X - X X
1253http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001254http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001255http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001257http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01001258tcp-check connect - - X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001259tcp-check expect - - X X
1260tcp-check send - - X X
1261tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001262http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001263id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001264ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001265log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001266maxconn X X X -
1267mode X X X X
1268monitor fail - X X -
1269monitor-net X X X -
1270monitor-uri X X X -
1271option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1272option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1273option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1274option allbackups (*) X - X X
1275option checkcache (*) X - X X
1276option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1277option contstats (*) X X X -
1278option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1279option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1280option forceclose (*) X X X X
1281-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1282option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001283option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001284option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001285option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001287option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001288option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1289option httpchk X - X X
1290option httpclose (*) X X X X
1291option httplog X X X X
1292option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001293option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001294option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001295option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1296option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1297option logasap (*) X X X -
1298option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001299option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300option nolinger (*) X X X X
1301option originalto X X X X
1302option persist (*) X - X X
1303option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001304option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001305option smtpchk X - X X
1306option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1307option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1308option splice-request (*) X X X X
1309option splice-response (*) X X X X
1310option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1311option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1312-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001313option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1315option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1316option tcpka X X X X
1317option tcplog X X X X
1318option transparent (*) X - X X
1319persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1320rate-limit sessions X X X -
1321redirect - X X X
1322redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1323redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1324reqadd - X X X
1325reqallow - X X X
1326reqdel - X X X
1327reqdeny - X X X
1328reqiallow - X X X
1329reqidel - X X X
1330reqideny - X X X
1331reqipass - X X X
1332reqirep - X X X
1333reqisetbe - X X X
1334reqitarpit - X X X
1335reqpass - X X X
1336reqrep - X X X
1337-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1338reqsetbe - X X X
1339reqtarpit - X X X
1340retries X - X X
1341rspadd - X X X
1342rspdel - X X X
1343rspdeny - X X X
1344rspidel - X X X
1345rspideny - X X X
1346rspirep - X X X
1347rsprep - X X X
1348server - - X X
1349source X - X X
1350srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001351stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001352stats auth X - X X
1353stats enable X - X X
1354stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001355stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001356stats realm X - X X
1357stats refresh X - X X
1358stats scope X - X X
1359stats show-desc X - X X
1360stats show-legends X - X X
1361stats show-node X - X X
1362stats uri X - X X
1363-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1364stick match - - X X
1365stick on - - X X
1366stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001367stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001369tcp-request connection - X X -
1370tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001371tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001372tcp-response content - - X X
1373tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001374timeout check X - X X
1375timeout client X X X -
1376timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1377timeout connect X - X X
1378timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1379timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1380timeout http-request X X X X
1381timeout queue X - X X
1382timeout server X - X X
1383timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1384timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001385timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001386transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001387unique-id-format X X X -
1388unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001389use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001390use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001391------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1392 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013954.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1396---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001397
1398This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1399
1400
1401acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1402 Declare or complete an access list.
1403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1404 no | yes | yes | yes
1405 Example:
1406 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1407 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1408 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001410 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001411
1412
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001413appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1414 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001415 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1417 no | no | yes | yes
1418 Arguments :
1419 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1420 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1421
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001422 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423 checked in each cookie value.
1424
1425 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1426 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1427 milliseconds.
1428
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001429 request-learn
1430 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1431 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1432 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1433 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1434 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1435 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1436
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001437 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1438 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1439 data following this prefix.
1440
1441 Example :
1442 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1443
1444 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1445 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1446
1447 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1448 2 modes are currently supported :
1449 - path-parameters :
1450 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1451 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1452 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1453 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1454 - query-string :
1455 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1456 query string.
1457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1459 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1460 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1461 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001462 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1463 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1464 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1466 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1467
1468 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1469
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001470 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1471 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1472 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474 Example :
1475 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1476
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001477 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1478 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001481backlog <conns>
1482 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1484 yes | yes | yes | no
1485 Arguments :
1486 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1487 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001488 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001489
1490 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1491 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1492 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1493 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1494 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1495 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1496 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1497 backlog parameter.
1498
1499 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1500 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1501 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1502
1503 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1504
1505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001507balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1510 yes | no | yes | yes
1511 Arguments :
1512 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1513 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1514 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1515 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1516
1517 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1518 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1519 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1520 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001521 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001522 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001523 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1524 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1525 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1526 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1527 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1528 it, so that you don't worry.
1529
1530 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1531 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1532 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1533 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1534 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1535 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1536 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1537 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001538
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001539 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1540 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1541 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1542 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1543 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1544 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1545 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1546 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1547
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001548 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001549 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001550 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1551 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001552 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001553 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1554 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1555 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1556 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1557 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001558 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1559 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1560 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1561 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1562 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1563 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1566 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1567 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1568 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1569 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1570 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1571 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1572 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001573 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001575 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1576 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1577 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001579 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1580 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1581 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1582 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1583 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1584 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1585 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1586 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1587 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1588 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1589 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1590 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001592 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001593 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1594 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1595 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1596 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1597 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1598 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1599 URIs start with a leading "/".
1600
1601 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1602 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1603 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1604 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001607 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1608
1609 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001610 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1611 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1612 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1613 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1614 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1615 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1616 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1617 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1618 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1619 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1620 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1621 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1622 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1623 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1624 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1625 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1626 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1627 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1628 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001629
1630 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1631 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1632 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1633 server will receive the request.
1634
1635 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1636 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1637 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1638 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1639 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001640 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1641 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1642 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001644 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1645 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1646 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1647 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1648 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001650 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001651 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1652 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1653 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1654
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001655 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1656 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1657 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1658
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001659 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001660 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001661 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1662 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1663 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1664 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1665 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1666 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001667 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001668 used instead.
1669
1670 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1671 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1672 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1673 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1674
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001675 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1676 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1677 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1678
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001679 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001682 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1683 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001684
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001685 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001686 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001687
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001688 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1689 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1690 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691
1692 Examples :
1693 balance roundrobin
1694 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001695 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001696 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1697 balance hdr(host)
1698 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001699
1700 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1701 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001703 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001704 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1705 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1706 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1707 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1708
1709 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1710 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1711 defaults to 16 kB.
1712
1713 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1714 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1715
1716 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1717 Round Robin.
1718
1719 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1720 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1721 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1722 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1723
1724 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1725
1726 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001728 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1729 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1730 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001732 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1733 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734
1735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001736bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1737bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1740 no | yes | yes | no
1741 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001742 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1743 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1744 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1745 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001746 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001747 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1748 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1749 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1750 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1751 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1752 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1753 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001754 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1755 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1756 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001757 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1758 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1759 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1760 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001761
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001762 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1763 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001764 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1765 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1766 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001767 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1768 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1769 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1770 the range.
1771
1772 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1773 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1774 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1775 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1776 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1777 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1778 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001780 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001782 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1783 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1784 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1785 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1786 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1787 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1788 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1789 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1792 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1793 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1794 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1797 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1798 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1799 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1800 in a frontend.
1801
1802 Example :
1803 listen http_proxy
1804 bind :80,:443
1805 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001806 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001808 listen http_https_proxy
1809 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001810 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001811
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001812 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1813 bind ipv6@:80
1814 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1815 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1816
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001817 listen external_bind_app1
1818 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1819
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001821 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822
1823
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001824bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001825 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1827 yes | yes | yes | yes
1828 Arguments :
1829 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1830 may be used to override a default value.
1831
1832 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1833 option may be combined with other numbers.
1834
1835 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1836 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1837 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1838 missing from all processes.
1839
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001840 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1841 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1842 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1843 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1844 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001845
1846 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1847 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1848 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1849 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1850 and 'even' instances.
1851
1852 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1853 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1854 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1855 32.
1856
1857 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1858 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1859
1860 Example :
1861 listen app_ip1
1862 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001863 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001864
1865 listen app_ip2
1866 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001867 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001868
1869 listen management
1870 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001871 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001872
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001873 listen management
1874 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1875 bind-process 1-4
1876
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001877 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1878
1879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880block { if | unless } <condition>
1881 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1883 no | yes | yes | yes
1884
1885 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1886 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001887 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001888 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1890 "block" statements per instance.
1891
1892 Example:
1893 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1894 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1895 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1896 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001898 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
1900
1901capture cookie <name> len <length>
1902 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1904 no | yes | yes | no
1905 Arguments :
1906 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1907 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1908 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1909 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1910 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1911
1912 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1913 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1914 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1915 right if it exceeds <length>.
1916
1917 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1918 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1919 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1920 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1921
1922 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1923 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1924 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1925
1926 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1927 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1928 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001929 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1930 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1931 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001932
1933 Example:
1934 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1935
1936 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001937 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
1939
1940capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001941 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 no | yes | yes | no
1944 Arguments :
1945 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001946 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001947 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1948 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1949 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1950
1951 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1952 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1953 it exceeds <length>.
1954
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001955 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1957 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001958 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1959 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1960 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1961 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001962 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001963 environments to find where the request came from.
1964
1965 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1966 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1967 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1968 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001970 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1971 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1972 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1973 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1974 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975
1976 Example:
1977 capture request header Host len 15
1978 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1979 capture request header Referrer len 15
1980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001981 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982 about logging.
1983
1984
1985capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001986 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1988 no | yes | yes | no
1989 Arguments :
1990 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001991 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1993 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1994 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1995
1996 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1997 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1998 it exceeds <length>.
1999
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002000 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2002 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2003 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002004 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2005 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2006 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2007 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002009 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2010 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2011 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2012 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2013 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
2015 Example:
2016 capture response header Content-length len 9
2017 capture response header Location len 15
2018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002019 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 about logging.
2021
2022
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002023clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2026 yes | yes | yes | no
2027 Arguments :
2028 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2030 as explained at the top of this document.
2031
2032 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2033 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2034 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2035 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2036 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2037 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2038 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2039 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002040 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2042 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2043
2044 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2045 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2046 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2047 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2048 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2049 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2050
2051 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2052 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2053
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002054 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2055 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002057compression algo <algorithm> ...
2058compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002059compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002060 Enable HTTP compression.
2061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2062 yes | yes | yes | yes
2063 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002064 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2065 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2066 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2067
2068 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002069 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002070 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2071 data.
2072
2073 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2074 support for zlib was built in.
2075
2076 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2077 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2078 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2079 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2080 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2081 in.
2082
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002083 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002084 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002085 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2086 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2087 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2088 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2089 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002090
2091 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2092 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2093 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2094 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2095 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002096 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2097 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2098 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2099 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2100 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2101 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002102
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002103 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002104 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2105 "Accept-Encoding" header
2106 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002107 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002108 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2109 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002110 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2111 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2112 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2113 "multipart"
2114 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2115 header
2116 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2117 and later
2118 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2119 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002120
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002121 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2122 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002123
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002124 Examples :
2125 compression algo gzip
2126 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2131 yes | no | yes | yes
2132 Arguments :
2133 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2135 as explained at the top of this document.
2136
2137 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002138 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002139 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2141 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2142 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2143 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2144
2145 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2146 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2147 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2148 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2149 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2150 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2151
2152 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2153 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2154 instead.
2155
2156 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2157 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2158
2159
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002160cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002161 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2162 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | no | yes | yes
2166 Arguments :
2167 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2168 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2169 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2170 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2171 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2172 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2173 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2174 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2175 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2176
2177 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2178 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2179 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2180 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2181 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2182 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2183 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2184 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2185 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2186 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2187 "insert" and "prefix".
2188
2189 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002190 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002191
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002192 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002193 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2194 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2195 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2196 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2197 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2198 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2199 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2200 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2201 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2202 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
2204 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2205 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2206 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2207 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2208 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2209 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2210 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2211 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2212 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2213 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002214 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2215 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2216 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002218 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2219 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2220 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002221 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2222 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2223 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2224 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002225 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2226 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2227 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228
2229 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2230 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2231 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2232 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2233 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2234 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2235 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2236 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2237 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2238
2239 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2240 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2241 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2242 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2243 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2244 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2245 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2246 persistence cookie in the cache.
2247 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2248
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002249 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2250 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2251 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2252 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2253 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2254 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2255 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2256 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2257 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2258 they logout.
2259
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002260 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2261 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2262 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2263 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2264
2265 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2266 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2267 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2268 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2269 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2270 this attribute.
2271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002272 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002273 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002274 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2275 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2276 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2277 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2278 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2279 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002281 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2282 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2283 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2284 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2285 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2286 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2287 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2288 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2289 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2290 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2291 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2292 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2293 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2294 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2295 the site.
2296
2297 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2298 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2299 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2300 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2301 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2302 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2303 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2304 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2305 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2306 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2307 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2308 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2309 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2310 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2311 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2312 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2315 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2316 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2317 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319 Examples :
2320 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2321 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2322 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002323 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002325 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002326 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002329default-server [param*]
2330 Change default options for a server in a backend
2331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2332 yes | no | yes | yes
2333 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002334 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2335 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2336 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2337 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002338
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002339 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002340 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2341
2342 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345default_backend <backend>
2346 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2348 yes | yes | yes | no
2349 Arguments :
2350 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2351
2352 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2353 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2354 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2355 will catch all undetermined requests.
2356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357 Example :
2358
2359 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2360 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2361 default_backend dynamic
2362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002363 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002366description <string>
2367 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370 Arguments : string
2371
2372 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2373 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2374 it describes.
2375 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2376
2377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378disabled
2379 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2381 yes | yes | yes | yes
2382 Arguments : none
2383
2384 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2385 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2386 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2387 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2388 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2389 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2390 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2391
2392 See also : "enabled"
2393
2394
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002395dispatch <address>:<port>
2396 Set a default server address
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002399 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002400
2401 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2402 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2403 during start-up.
2404
2405 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2406 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2407 possible with normal servers.
2408
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002409 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002410 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2411 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2412 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2413 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2414
2415 See also : "server"
2416
2417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418enabled
2419 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2421 yes | yes | yes | yes
2422 Arguments : none
2423
2424 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2425 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2426
2427 See also : "disabled"
2428
2429
2430errorfile <code> <file>
2431 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2433 yes | yes | yes | yes
2434 Arguments :
2435 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002436 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437
2438 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002439 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002441 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2442 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443
2444 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2445 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2446 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2447
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002448 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2451 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2452 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2453 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2454
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002455 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2456 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2457 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2458 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2459 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2460 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2463 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2464 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002465 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2467
2468 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2469
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002470 Example :
2471 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2472 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2473 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002475
2476errorloc <code> <url>
2477errorloc302 <code> <url>
2478 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 yes | yes | yes | yes
2481 Arguments :
2482 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002483 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484
2485 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2486 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2487 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2488 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2489 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2490
2491 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2492 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2493 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2494
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002495 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002497 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2498 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2499 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2500 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2501 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2502 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2503 request.
2504
2505 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2506
2507
2508errorloc303 <code> <url>
2509 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2511 yes | yes | yes | yes
2512 Arguments :
2513 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2514 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2515
2516 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2517 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2518 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2519 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2520 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2521
2522 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2523 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2524 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2525
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002526 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2527
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002528 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2529 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2530 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2531 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002532 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002533
2534 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2535
2536
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002537force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2538 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 no | yes | yes | yes
2541
2542 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2543 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2544 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2545 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2546 marked down for maintenance operations.
2547
2548 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2549 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2550 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2551 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2552 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2553 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2554 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2555 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2556 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2557
2558 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2559 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2560 is used.
2561
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002562 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002563 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002564
2565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002566fullconn <conns>
2567 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2569 yes | no | yes | yes
2570 Arguments :
2571 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2572 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2573
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002574 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002575 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002576 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2578 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2579 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2580 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2581 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002582 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002584 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2585 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002586 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2587 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2588 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 Example :
2591 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2592 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2593 # connections.
2594 backend dynamic
2595 fullconn 10000
2596 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2597 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2598
2599 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2600
2601
2602grace <time>
2603 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002605 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002606 Arguments :
2607 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2608 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2609 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2610
2611 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2612 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002613 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2615
2616 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2617 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2618 simplify it.
2619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002621hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002622 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2624 yes | no | yes | yes
2625 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002626 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2627 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002628
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002629 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2630 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2631 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2632 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2633 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2634 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2635 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2636 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2637 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2638 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002639
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002640 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2641 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2642 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2643 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2644 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2645 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2646 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2647 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2648 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2649 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2650 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2651 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2652 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002653 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2654 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002655
2656 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2657
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002658 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002659 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2660 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2661 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002662 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2663 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2664 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002665
2666 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2667 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002668 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2669 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2670 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2671 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2672
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002673 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2674 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2675 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2676 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2677 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2678 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2679 parameter.
2680
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002681 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2682
2683 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2684 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2685 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2686 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2687 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2688 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2689 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2690 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2691 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2692 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2693 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2694 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002695
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002696 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2697 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2698 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002699
2700 See also : "balance", "server"
2701
2702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703http-check disable-on-404
2704 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002706 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707 Arguments : none
2708
2709 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2710 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2711 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2712 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2713 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2714 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2715 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2716 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002717 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2718 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2719 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2720
2721 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2722
2723
2724http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002725 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002727 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002728 Arguments :
2729 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2730 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002731 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002732 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2733 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2734 details on the supported keywords.
2735
2736 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2737 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2738 with the usual backslash ('\').
2739
2740 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2741 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2742 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2743 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2744 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2745
2746 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002747 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002748 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2749 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2750 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2751
2752 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002753 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002754 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2755 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2756 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2757 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2758
2759 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002760 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002761 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2762 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2763 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2764 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2765 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2766 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2767 trace).
2768
2769 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002770 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002771 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2772 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2773 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2774 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2775 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2776 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2777
2778 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2779 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2780 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2781 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2782 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2783 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2784 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2785 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2786
2787 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2788 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2789
2790 Examples :
2791 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002792 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002793
2794 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002795 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002796
2797 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002798 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002799
2800 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002801 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002802
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002803 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002804
2805
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002806http-check send-state
2807 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2809 yes | no | yes | yes
2810 Arguments : none
2811
2812 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2813 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2814 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2815 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2816 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2817
2818 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2819 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2820 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2821 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2822 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2823 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2824 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2825 checked in multiple backends.
2826
2827 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2828 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2829
2830 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2831 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2832 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2833 one fails.
2834
2835 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2836 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2837 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2838
2839 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2840 server's queue.
2841
2842 Example of a header received by the application server :
2843 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2844 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2845
2846 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2847
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002848http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002849 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002850 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
2851 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002852 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002853 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2854
2855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2856 no | yes | yes | yes
2857
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002858 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2859 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2860 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2861 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2862 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002863
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002864 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2865 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2866 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2867
2868 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2869 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2870 are evaluated.
2871
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002872 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2873 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2874 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2875 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2876 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2877 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2878 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2879 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2880 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002881 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002882 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002884 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2885 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2886 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2887 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2888 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2889
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002890 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2891 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2892 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002893 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2894 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002895
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002896 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2897 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2898 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2899 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2900 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2901 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2902 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2903 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2904
2905 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2906 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2907 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2908 external users.
2909
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002910 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2911 <name>.
2912
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002913 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2914 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2915 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2916 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2917 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2918 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2919 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2920 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2921
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002922 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2923 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2924 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2925 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2926 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2927 another equipment.
2928
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002929 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2930 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2931 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2932 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2933 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2934 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2935 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2936 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2937
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002938 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2939 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2940 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2941 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2942 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2943 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2944 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2945 admin privileges.
2946
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002947 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2948
2949 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2950 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2951 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2952 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002953
2954 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002955 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2956 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2957 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002958
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002959 http-request allow if nagios
2960 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2961 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2962 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002963
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002964 Example:
2965 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002966 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002967
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002968 Example:
2969 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2970 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2971 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2972 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2973 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2974 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2975 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2976 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2977 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2978
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002979 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2980 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002981
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002982http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002983 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
2984 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002985 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002986 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2987
2988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2989 no | yes | yes | yes
2990
2991 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2992 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2993 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2994 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2995 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2996 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2997
2998 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2999 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3000 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3001 current section.
3002
3003 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3004 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3005 rules are evaluated.
3006
3007 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3008 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3009 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3010 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3011 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3012 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3013 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3014
3015 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3016 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3017 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3018 external users.
3019
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003020 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3021 <name>.
3022
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003023 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3024 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3025 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3026 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3027 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3028 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3029 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3030 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3031
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003032 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3033 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3034 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3035 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3036 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3037 another equipment.
3038
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003039 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3040 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3041 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3042 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3043 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3044 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3045 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3046 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3047
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003048 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3049 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3050 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3051 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3052 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3053 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3054 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3055 admin privileges.
3056
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003057 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3058
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003059 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003060 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3061 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3062 rules.
3063
3064 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3065 ACL usage.
3066
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003067
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003068tcp-check connect [params*]
3069 Opens a new connection
3070 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3071 no | no | yes | yes
3072
3073 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
3074 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
3075 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
3076
3077 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
3078 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
3079 of the sequence.
3080
3081 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
3082 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
3083 do.
3084
3085 Parameters :
3086 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
3087 use the TCP connection.
3088
3089 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
3090 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
3091 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
3092
3093 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
3094
3095 ssl opens a ciphered connection
3096
3097 Examples:
3098 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
3099 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
3100 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
3101 option tcp-check
3102 tcp-check connect
3103 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3104 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3105 tcp-check send \r\n
3106 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3107 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
3108 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3109 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3110 tcp-check send \r\n
3111 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3112 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
3113
3114 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
3115 option tcp-check
3116 tcp-check connect port 110
3117 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3118 tcp-check connect port 143
3119 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3120 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
3121
3122 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
3123
3124
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003125tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
3126 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
3127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 no | no | yes | yes
3129
3130 Arguments :
3131 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3132 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
3133 binary.
3134 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
3135 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
3136 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
3137
3138 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3139 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3140 with the usual backslash ('\').
3141 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
3142 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
3143 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
3144 used upper or lower case.
3145
3146
3147 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3148
3149 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3150 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3151 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3152 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3153 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3154 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3155 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3156 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3157
3158 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3160 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3161 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3162 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3163 expression.
3164
3165 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3166 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3167 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3168 this exact hexadecimal string.
3169 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3170
3171 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3172 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3173 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3174 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3175 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3176 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3177 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3178 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3179 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3180 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3181 the null character.
3182
3183 Examples :
3184 # perform a POP check
3185 option tcp-check
3186 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3187
3188 # perform an IMAP check
3189 option tcp-check
3190 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3191
3192 # look for the redis master server
3193 option tcp-check
3194 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3195 tcp-check expect +PONG
3196 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3197 tcp-check expect string role:master
3198 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3199 tcp-check expect string +OK
3200
3201
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003202 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
3203 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003204
3205
3206tcp-check send <data>
3207 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 no | no | yes | yes
3210
3211 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3212 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3213
3214 Examples :
3215 # look for the redis master server
3216 option tcp-check
3217 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3218 tcp-check expect string role:master
3219
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003220 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3221 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003222
3223
3224tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3225 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3226 tcp health check
3227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3228 no | no | yes | yes
3229
3230 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3231 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3232 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3233 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3234 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3235 hexadecimal string.
3236 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3237
3238 Examples :
3239 # redis check in binary
3240 option tcp-check
3241 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3242 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3243
3244
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003245 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3246 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003247
3248
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003249http-send-name-header [<header>]
3250 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3251
3252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3253 yes | no | yes | yes
3254
3255 Arguments :
3256
3257 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3258
3259 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3260 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3261 is added with the header string proved.
3262
3263 See also : "server"
3264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003265id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003266 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3268 no | yes | yes | yes
3269 Arguments : none
3270
3271 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3272 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3273 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003274
3275
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003276ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3277 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3279 no | yes | yes | yes
3280
3281 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3282 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3283 and running).
3284
3285 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3286 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3287 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003288 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003289 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3290
3291 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3292 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3293
3294 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3295 "unless" condition is met.
3296
3297 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3298
3299
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003300log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003301log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003302no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003303 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3305 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003306
3307 Prefix :
3308 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3309 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3310 prefix does not allow arguments.
3311
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003312 Arguments :
3313 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3314 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3315 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3316 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3317 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3318 parameter.
3319
3320 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3321 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3322
3323 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3324 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3325 standard syslog port).
3326
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003327 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3328 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3329 standard syslog port).
3330
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003331 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3332 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3333 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3334 appropriately writeable).
3335
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003336 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3337 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3338 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3339 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3340
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003341 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3342
3343 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3344 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3345 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3346
3347 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3348 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3349 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003350 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3351 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3352 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3353 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3354 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003355
3356 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3357
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003358 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3359 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3360 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003361
3362 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3363 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3364 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3365 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3366
3367 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3368 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003369
3370 Example :
3371 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003372 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3373 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003374 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3375
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003376
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003377log-format <string>
3378 Allows you to custom a log line.
3379
3380 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3381
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003382
3383maxconn <conns>
3384 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | no
3387 Arguments :
3388 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3389 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3390 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3391 closes.
3392
3393 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3394 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3395 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3396 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3397 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3398 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3399 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3400 properly tuned.
3401
3402 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3403 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3404 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3405
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003406 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003408 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3409
3410
3411mode { tcp|http|health }
3412 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | yes | yes | yes
3415 Arguments :
3416 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3417 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3418 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3419 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3420
3421 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3422 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3423 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3424 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3425 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3426
3427 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003428 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3429 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3430 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3431 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3432 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3433 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3434 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003435
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003436 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3437 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3438 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003439
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003440 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003441 defaults http_instances
3442 mode http
3443
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003444 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003446
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003447monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003448 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3450 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451 Arguments :
3452 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3453 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003454 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3456 backend and its backup.
3457
3458 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3459 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3460 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3461 servers in a list of backends.
3462
3463 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3464 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3465 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3466 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3467 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3468 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3469 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003470 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3471 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472
3473 Example:
3474 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003475 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3477 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3478 monitor-uri /site_alive
3479 monitor fail if site_dead
3480
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003481 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482
3483
3484monitor-net <source>
3485 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | yes | yes | no
3488 Arguments :
3489 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3490 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3491 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3492 followed by a mask.
3493
3494 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3495 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003496 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003497 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3498
3499 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3500 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3501 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3502 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003503 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3504 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3505 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003506
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003507 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3508 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3509 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3510 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3511 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3512 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003513
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003514 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3515 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003516
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003517 Example :
3518 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3519 frontend www
3520 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3521
3522 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3523
3524
3525monitor-uri <uri>
3526 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3528 yes | yes | yes | no
3529 Arguments :
3530 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3531 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3532
3533 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3534 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3535 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3536 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3537 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3538 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3539 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3540 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3541
3542 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3543 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3544 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3545 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3546 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3547 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3548
3549 Example :
3550 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3551 frontend www
3552 mode http
3553 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3554
3555 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003557
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003558option abortonclose
3559no option abortonclose
3560 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3562 yes | no | yes | yes
3563 Arguments : none
3564
3565 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3566 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3567 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3568 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003569 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003570 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3571 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3572 encountered while delivering the response.
3573
3574 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3575 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3576 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3577 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3578 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3579 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003580 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003581 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003582 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003583 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3584 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3585 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3586
3587 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3588 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3589 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3590 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3591 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3592 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3593 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3594 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003595 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003596
3597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3599
3600 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3601
3602
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003603option accept-invalid-http-request
3604no option accept-invalid-http-request
3605 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3607 yes | yes | yes | no
3608 Arguments : none
3609
3610 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3611 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3612 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3613 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3614 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3615 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3616 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3617 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003618 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3619 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3620 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3621 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3622 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3623 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003624
3625 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3626 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3627 been confirmed.
3628
3629 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3630 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003631 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3632 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003633 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3634
3635 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3636 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3637
3638 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3639 stats socket.
3640
3641
3642option accept-invalid-http-response
3643no option accept-invalid-http-response
3644 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | no | yes | yes
3647 Arguments : none
3648
3649 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3650 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3651 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3652 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3653 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3654 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3655 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3656 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3657 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3658
3659 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3660 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3661 been confirmed.
3662
3663 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3664 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3665 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3666 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3667
3668 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3669 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3670
3671 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3672 stats socket.
3673
3674
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003675option allbackups
3676no option allbackups
3677 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | no | yes | yes
3680 Arguments : none
3681
3682 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3683 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3684 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3685 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3686 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3687 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3688 order between the backup servers anymore.
3689
3690 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3691 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3692
3693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3695
3696
3697option checkcache
3698no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003699 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 yes | no | yes | yes
3702 Arguments : none
3703
3704 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3705 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003706 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003707 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3708 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003709 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003710
3711 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003712 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003713 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003714 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3715 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003716 to the client are :
3717 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003718 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003719 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003720 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3721 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3722 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3723 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3724 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3725 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3726 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3727 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3728 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3729 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3730 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3731
3732 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003733 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003734 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003735 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003736 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3737
3738 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3739 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003740 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003741 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3742
3743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3745
3746
3747option clitcpka
3748no option clitcpka
3749 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | yes | yes | no
3752 Arguments : none
3753
3754 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3755 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3756 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3757 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3758
3759 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3760 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3761 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3762 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3763
3764 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3765 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3766 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3767 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3768 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3769
3770 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3771
3772 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3773 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3774 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3775
3776 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3777 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3778
3779 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3780
3781
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782option contstats
3783 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3785 yes | yes | yes | no
3786 Arguments : none
3787
3788 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3789 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3790 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3791 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3792 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3793 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3794 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3795
3796
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003797option dontlog-normal
3798no option dontlog-normal
3799 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | yes | yes | no
3802 Arguments : none
3803
3804 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3805 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3806 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3807 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3808 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3809 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3810 logged.
3811
3812 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3813 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3814 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003816 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003817 logging.
3818
3819
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003820option dontlognull
3821no option dontlognull
3822 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3824 yes | yes | yes | no
3825 Arguments : none
3826
3827 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3828 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3829 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3830 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3831 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3832 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3833 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3834
3835 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3836 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3837 would not be logged.
3838
3839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003842 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003843
3844
3845option forceclose
3846no option forceclose
3847 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850 Arguments : none
3851
3852 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3853 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3854 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3855 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3856 global session times in the logs.
3857
3858 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003859 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003860 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003861
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003862 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3863 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3864 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3865
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003866 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3867 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003868
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3871
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003872 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003873
3874
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003875option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003876 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3878 yes | yes | yes | yes
3879 Arguments :
3880 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3881 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003882 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003883 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003884
3885 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3886 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3887 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3888 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3889 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3890 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3891 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003892 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3893 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3894 possible that the client has already brought one.
3895
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003896 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003897 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003898 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3899 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003900 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3901 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003902
3903 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3904 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3905 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3906 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3907 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3908 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3909 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3910
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003911 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3912 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3913 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3914 are under the control of the end-user.
3915
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003916 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003917 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3918 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003919 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3920 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3921 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003922
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003923 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003924 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3925 frontend www
3926 mode http
3927 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3928
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003929 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3930 backend www
3931 mode http
3932 option forwardfor header X-Client
3933
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003934 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003935 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003936
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003937
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003938option http-keep-alive
3939no option http-keep-alive
3940 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3942 yes | yes | yes | yes
3943 Arguments : none
3944
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003945 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3946 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3947 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3948 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3949 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3950 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3951 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3952
3953 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3954 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003955 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3956 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3957 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3958 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3959 situations where this option may be useful :
3960
3961 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3962 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3963
3964 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3965 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3966
3967 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3968 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3969 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3970 request.
3971
3972 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3973 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003974 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3975 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3976 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003977
3978 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3979 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3980
3981 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3982 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3983 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3984 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3985 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3986 not set.
3987
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003988 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3989 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003990 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003991 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003992
3993 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003994 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3995 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003996
3997
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003998option http-no-delay
3999no option http-no-delay
4000 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4002 yes | yes | yes | yes
4003 Arguments : none
4004
4005 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4006 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4007 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4008 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4009 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4010 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4011 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4012 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4013 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4014 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4015 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4016 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4017 affected.
4018
4019 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4020 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4021 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4022 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4023 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4024 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4025 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4026 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4027 latency environments.
4028
4029
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004030option http-pretend-keepalive
4031no option http-pretend-keepalive
4032 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | yes | yes | yes
4035 Arguments : none
4036
4037 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4038 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4039 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4040 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4041 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4042 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4043 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4044 consider the response complete.
4045
4046 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4047 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4048 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4049 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4050 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4051 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4052
4053 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4054 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4055 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4056 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4057 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4058 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4059 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4060
4061 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4062 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004063 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004064 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4065 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004066
4067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4069
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004070 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4071 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004072
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004073
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004074option http-server-close
4075no option http-server-close
4076 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4078 yes | yes | yes | yes
4079 Arguments : none
4080
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004081 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4082 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4083 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4084 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4085 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4086 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4087 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4088 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4089 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4090 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4091 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4092 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4093 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4094 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4095 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4096 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004097
4098 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4099 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4100 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4101 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004102 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4103 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004104
4105 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4106 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004107 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4108 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004109 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4110 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004111
4112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4114
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004115 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004116 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4117 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004118
4119
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004120option http-tunnel
4121no option http-tunnel
4122 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | yes | yes | yes
4125 Arguments : none
4126
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004127 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4128 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4129 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4130 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4131 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4132 "option http-tunnel".
4133
4134 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004135 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004136 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4137 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4138 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4139 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4140 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4141 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4142 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004143
4144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4146
4147 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4148 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4149 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4150
4151
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004152option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004153no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004154 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4156 yes | yes | yes | no
4157 Arguments : none
4158
4159 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4160 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4161 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4162 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4163 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4164 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4165 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4166
4167 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4168 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4169 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4170 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4171 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4172 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4173 request along its whole life.
4174
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004175 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4176 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4177 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4178 front of an existing proxy.
4179
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004180 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4181
4182 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4183 http-server-close".
4184
4185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004186option httpchk
4187option httpchk <uri>
4188option httpchk <method> <uri>
4189option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4190 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | no | yes | yes
4193 Arguments :
4194 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4195 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4196 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4197 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4198 ones.
4199
4200 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4201 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4202 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4203
4204 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4205 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4206 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4207 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4208 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4209
4210 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4211 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4212 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4213 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4214 the lack of any response.
4215
4216 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4217
4218 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4219 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4220 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4221
4222 Examples :
4223 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4224 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4225 backend https_relay
4226 mode tcp
4227 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4228 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4229
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004230 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4231 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4232 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004233
4234
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004235option httpclose
4236no option httpclose
4237 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4239 yes | yes | yes | yes
4240 Arguments : none
4241
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004242 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4243 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4244 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4245 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004246 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004247 "option http-tunnel".
4248
4249 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4250 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4251 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4252 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4253 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4254 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4255 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4256 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004257
4258 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004259 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004260 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4261 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4262 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4263 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4264 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004265
4266 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4267 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004268 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4269 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004270 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4271 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004272
4273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4275
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004276 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4277 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004278
4279
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004280option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004281 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004284 Arguments :
4285 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4286 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4287 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4288 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4289 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004290
4291 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4292 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4293 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4294 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4295 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4296 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4297 ports.
4298
4299 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4300
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4303 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4304 by default.
4305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004306 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004307
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004308
4309option http_proxy
4310no option http_proxy
4311 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 yes | yes | yes | yes
4314 Arguments : none
4315
4316 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4317 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4318 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4319 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4320 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4321
4322 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4323 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4324 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4325 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004326 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004327 be analyzed.
4328
4329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4331
4332 Example :
4333 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4334 backend direct_forward
4335 option httpclose
4336 option http_proxy
4337
4338 See also : "option httpclose"
4339
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004340
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004341option independent-streams
4342no option independent-streams
4343 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4345 yes | yes | yes | yes
4346 Arguments : none
4347
4348 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4349 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4350 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4351 receive data or not.
4352
4353 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4354 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4355 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4356 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4357 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4358 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4359 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4360 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4361 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4362 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4363 socket buffers.
4364
4365 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4366 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4367 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4368 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4369 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4370
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004371 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004372 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4373 deprecated.
4374
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004375 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004376
4377
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004378option ldap-check
4379 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | no | yes | yes
4382 Arguments : none
4383
4384 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4385 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4386 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4387 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4388
4389 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4390 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4391
4392 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4393 configure it.
4394
4395 Example :
4396 option ldap-check
4397
4398 See also : "option httpchk"
4399
4400
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004401option log-health-checks
4402no option log-health-checks
4403 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4405 yes | no | yes | yes
4406 Arguments : none
4407
4408 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4409 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4410 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4411 of additional information is limited.
4412
4413 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4414 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4415
4416 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4417
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004418
4419option log-separate-errors
4420no option log-separate-errors
4421 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4423 yes | yes | yes | no
4424 Arguments : none
4425
4426 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4427 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4428 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4429 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4430 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4431 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4432 provides very important information.
4433
4434 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4435 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4436 error logs.
4437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004438 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004439 logging.
4440
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004441
4442option logasap
4443no option logasap
4444 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 yes | yes | yes | no
4447 Arguments : none
4448
4449 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4450 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4451 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4452 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4453 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4454 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4455 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004456 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004457 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4458 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4459
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004460 Examples :
4461 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4462 mode http
4463 option httplog
4464 option logasap
4465 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4466
4467 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4468 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4469 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4470 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004472 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004473 logging.
4474
4475
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004476option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4477 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004480 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004481 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4482 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004483
4484 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4485 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4486 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4487 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4488 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4489 in the MySQL table, like this :
4490
4491 USE mysql;
4492 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4493 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4494
4495 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4496 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4497 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4498 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4499 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4500 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4501 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4502 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4503 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4504
4505 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4506 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004507
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004508 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004509
4510 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4511 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4512 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4513 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4514 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4515 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4516
4517 See also: "option httpchk"
4518
4519
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004520option nolinger
4521no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004522 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004523 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004525 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004526
4527 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4528 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4529 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4530 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4531 connections.
4532
4533 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4534 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4535 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4536 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4537 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4538 this too.
4539
4540 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4541 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4542 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4543
4544 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4545 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4546 for servers.
4547
4548 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4549 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4550
4551
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004552option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4553 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4555 yes | yes | yes | yes
4556 Arguments :
4557 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4558 matching <network>
4559 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4560 header name.
4561
4562 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4563 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4564 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4565 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4566 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4567 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4568 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4569 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4570 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4571 possible that the client has already brought one.
4572
4573 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4574 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4575 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4576 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4577 header and requires different one.
4578
4579 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4580 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4581 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4582 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4583 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4584 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4585 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4586
4587 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4588 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4589 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4590 both are defined.
4591
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004592 Examples :
4593 # Original Destination address
4594 frontend www
4595 mode http
4596 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4597
4598 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4599 backend www
4600 mode http
4601 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4602
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004603 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4604 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004605
4606
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004607option persist
4608no option persist
4609 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004612 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004613
4614 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4615 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4616 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4617 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4618 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4619 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4620 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4621 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4622 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4623 redirected to another valid server.
4624
4625 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4626 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4627
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004628 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004629
4630
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004631option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4632 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 yes | no | yes | yes
4635 Arguments :
4636 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4637 PostgreSQL server.
4638
4639 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4640 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4641 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4642 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4643
4644 See also: "option httpchk"
4645
4646
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004647option prefer-last-server
4648no option prefer-last-server
4649 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 yes | no | yes | yes
4652 Arguments : none
4653
4654 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4655 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4656 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4657 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4658 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4659 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4660 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4661 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4662 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004663 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4664 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4665 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4666 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4667 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4668 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4669 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004670
4671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4673
4674 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4675
4676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004677option redispatch
4678no option redispatch
4679 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004682 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004683
4684 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4685 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4686 be able to access the service anymore.
4687
4688 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4689 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4690
4691 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4692 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4693 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004695 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4696 "redisp" keywords.
4697
4698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4700
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004701 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004702
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004703
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004704option redis-check
4705 Use redis health checks for server testing
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 yes | no | yes | yes
4708 Arguments : none
4709
4710 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4711 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4712 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4713 find the "+PONG" response message.
4714
4715 Example :
4716 option redis-check
4717
4718 See also : "option httpchk"
4719
4720
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004721option smtpchk
4722option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4723 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4725 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004726 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004727 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4728 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4729 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4730
4731 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4732 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4733 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4734
4735 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4736 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4737 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4738 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4739 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4740 dead server.
4741
4742 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4743 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4744 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4745 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4746
4747 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4748 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4749 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4750 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4751 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4752
4753 Example :
4754 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4755
4756 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004759option socket-stats
4760no option socket-stats
4761
4762 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 yes | yes | yes | no
4765
4766 Arguments : none
4767
4768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004769option splice-auto
4770no option splice-auto
4771 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | yes | yes | yes
4774 Arguments : none
4775
4776 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4777 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4778 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4779 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004780 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004781 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4782 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4783 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4784 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4785
4786 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4787 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4788 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4789 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4790 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4791 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4792 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4793 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4794 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4795 keyword.
4796
4797 Example :
4798 option splice-auto
4799
4800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4802
4803 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4804 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4805
4806
4807option splice-request
4808no option splice-request
4809 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | yes
4812 Arguments : none
4813
4814 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004815 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004816 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4817 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4818 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4819 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4820
4821 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4822
4823 Example :
4824 option splice-request
4825
4826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4828
4829 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4830 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4831
4832
4833option splice-response
4834no option splice-response
4835 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | yes | yes | yes
4838 Arguments : none
4839
4840 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004841 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004842 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4843 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4844 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4845 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4846
4847 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4848
4849 Example :
4850 option splice-response
4851
4852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4854
4855 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4856 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4857
4858
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004859option srvtcpka
4860no option srvtcpka
4861 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 yes | no | yes | yes
4864 Arguments : none
4865
4866 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4867 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4868 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4869 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4870
4871 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4872 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4873 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4874 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4875
4876 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4877 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4878 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4879 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4880 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4881
4882 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4883
4884 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4885 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4886 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4887
4888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4890
4891 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4892
4893
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004894option ssl-hello-chk
4895 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4897 yes | no | yes | yes
4898 Arguments : none
4899
4900 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4901 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4902 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4903 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4904 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4905 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4906 hello message.
4907
4908 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4909 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4910 messages, which is appreciable.
4911
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004912 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4913 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4914 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004915
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004916 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4917
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004918
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004919option tcp-check
4920 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 yes | no | yes | yes
4923
4924 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4925 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4926
4927 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4928 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4929 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4930
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004931 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004932 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4933 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4934 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4935 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4936 only.
4937
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004938 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004939 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4940 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4941 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4942 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4943
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004944 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004945 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4946 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004947 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004948 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4949 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4950 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4951 the respective protocols.
4952 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4953 analysed.
4954
4955 Examples :
4956 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4957 option tcp-check
4958 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4959
4960 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4961 option tcp-check
4962 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4963
4964 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4965 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004966 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004967 option tcp-check
4968 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4969 tcp-check expect +PONG
4970 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4971 tcp-check expect string role:master
4972 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4973 tcp-check expect string +OK
4974
4975 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4976 (send many headers before analyzing)
4977 option tcp-check
4978 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4979 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4980 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4981 tcp-check send \r\n
4982 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4983
4984
4985 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4986
4987
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004988option tcp-smart-accept
4989no option tcp-smart-accept
4990 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4992 yes | yes | yes | no
4993 Arguments : none
4994
4995 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4996 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4997 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4998 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4999 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5000 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5001
5002 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5003 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5004 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5005 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5006
5007 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5008 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5009 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5010 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5011
5012 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5013 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5014 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5015
5016 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5017 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5018 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5019
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005020 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5021
5022
5023option tcp-smart-connect
5024no option tcp-smart-connect
5025 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | no | yes | yes
5028 Arguments : none
5029
5030 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5031 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5032 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5033 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5034 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5035
5036 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5037 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5038 complex.
5039
5040 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5041 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5042 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5043
5044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5046
5047 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5048
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005049
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005050option tcpka
5051 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5053 yes | yes | yes | yes
5054 Arguments : none
5055
5056 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5057 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5058 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5059 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5060
5061 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5062 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5063 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5064 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5065
5066 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5067 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5068 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5069 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5070 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5071
5072 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5073
5074 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5075 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5076 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5077 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5078 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5079 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5080 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5081 backends.
5082
5083 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5084
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005085
5086option tcplog
5087 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5089 yes | yes | yes | yes
5090 Arguments : none
5091
5092 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5093 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5094 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5095 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5096 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5097 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5098 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5099 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5100
5101 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005104
5105
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005106option transparent
5107no option transparent
5108 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005110 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005111 Arguments : none
5112
5113 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5114 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5115 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5116 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5117 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5118 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5119 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5120 appropriate server.
5121
5122 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5123 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5124
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005125 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005126 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005127
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005128
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005129persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005130persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005131 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 yes | no | yes | yes
5134 Arguments :
5135 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005136 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5137 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005138
5139 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5140 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5141 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5142 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5143 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5144 forwarded to this server.
5145
5146 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5147 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5148 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005149 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005150 a single "listen" section.
5151
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005152 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5153 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5154 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5155
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005156 Example :
5157 listen tse-farm
5158 bind :3389
5159 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5160 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5161 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5162 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5163 persist rdp-cookie
5164 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005165 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005166 balance rdp-cookie
5167 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5168 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5169
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005170 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5171 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005172
5173
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005174rate-limit sessions <rate>
5175 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5177 yes | yes | yes | no
5178 Arguments :
5179 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5180 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5181
5182 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5183 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5184 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5185 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5186 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5187 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5188
5189 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5190 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5191 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5192 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5193
5194 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5195 listen smtp
5196 mode tcp
5197 bind :25
5198 rate-limit sessions 10
5199 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5200
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005201 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5202 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5203 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005204
5205 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5206
5207
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005208redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5209redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5210redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005211 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5213 no | yes | yes | yes
5214
5215 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005216 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005217
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005219 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005220 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5221 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5222 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005223
5224 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5225 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5226 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5227 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5228 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005229 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5230 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5231 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5232 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005233
5234 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5235 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5236 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5237 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5238 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5239 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005240 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005241 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005242 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5243 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5244 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005245
5246 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005247 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5248 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5249 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5250 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5251 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5252 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5253 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5254 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005255
5256 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5257 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5258
5259 - "drop-query"
5260 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5261 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5262 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5263 with a location-type redirect.
5264
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005265 - "append-slash"
5266 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5267 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5268 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5269 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5270
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005271 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5272 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5273 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5274 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5275 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5276 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5277 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5278
5279 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5280 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5281 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5282 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5283 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5284 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5285 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005286
5287 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5288 acl clear dst_port 80
5289 acl secure dst_port 8080
5290 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005291 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005292 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005293 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5294
5295 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005296 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5297 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5298 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005299 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005300
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005301 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5302 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5303 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5304
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005305 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005306 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005307
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005308 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5309 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5310 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005312 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005313
5314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005315redisp (deprecated)
5316redispatch (deprecated)
5317 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005320 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005321
5322 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5323 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5324 be able to access the service anymore.
5325
5326 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5327 redistribute them to a working server.
5328
5329 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5330 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5331 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005333 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5334 "option redispatch" instead.
5335
5336 See also : "option redispatch"
5337
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005338
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005339reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005340 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 no | yes | yes | yes
5343 Arguments :
5344 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5345 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005346 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005347
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005348 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5349 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5350
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005351 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5352 the last header of an HTTP request.
5353
5354 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5355 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5356 responses.
5357
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005358 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5359 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5360 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5361
5362 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5363 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005364
5365
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005366reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5367reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005368 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5370 no | yes | yes | yes
5371 Arguments :
5372 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5373 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5374 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5375 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5376 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5377 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5378 ignores case.
5379
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005380 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5381 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5382
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005383 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5384 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5385 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5386 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005387 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005388
5389 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5390 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5391
5392 Example :
5393 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5394 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5395 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5396
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005397 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5398 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005399
5400
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005401reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5402reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005403 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5405 no | yes | yes | yes
5406 Arguments :
5407 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5408 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5409 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5410 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5411 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5412 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5413
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005414 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5415 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5416
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005417 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5418 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5419 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5420 next servers.
5421
5422 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5423 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5424 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5425
5426 Example :
5427 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5428 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5429 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005431 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5432 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005433
5434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005435reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5436reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005437 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5439 no | yes | yes | yes
5440 Arguments :
5441 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5442 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5443 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5444 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5445 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5446 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5447 case.
5448
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005449 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5450 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5451
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005452 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5453 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5454 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5455 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005456 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005457
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005458 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005459 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005460 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005461
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005462 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5463 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5464
5465 Example :
5466 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5467 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5468 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005470 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5471 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005472
5473
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005474reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5475reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005476 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 no | yes | yes | yes
5479 Arguments :
5480 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5481 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5482 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5483 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5484 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5485 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5486 case.
5487
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005488 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5489 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5490
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005491 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5492 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5493 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5494 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5495
5496 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5497 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5498
5499 Example :
5500 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5501 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5502 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5503 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5504
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005505 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5506 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005507
5508
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005509reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5510reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005511 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5513 no | yes | yes | yes
5514 Arguments :
5515 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5516 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5517 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5518 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5519 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5520 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5521
5522 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5523 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5524 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5525 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005526 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005527
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005528 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5529 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5530
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005531 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5532 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5533 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5534
5535 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5536 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5537 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5538 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5539 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5540
5541 Example :
5542 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005543 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005544 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5545 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5546
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005547 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5548 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005549
5550
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005551reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5552reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005553 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5555 no | yes | yes | yes
5556 Arguments :
5557 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5558 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5559 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5560 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5561 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5562 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5563 ignores case.
5564
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005565 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5566 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5567
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005568 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5569 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005570 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5571 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5572 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005573 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5574 not set.
5575
5576 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5577 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5578 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5579 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5580 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5581
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005582 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005583 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5584 # block all others.
5585 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5586 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5587
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005588 # block bad guys
5589 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5590 reqitarpit . if badguys
5591
5592 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5593 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005594
5595
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005596retries <value>
5597 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5599 yes | no | yes | yes
5600 Arguments :
5601 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5602 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5603 default value is 3.
5604
5605 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5606 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5607 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5608
5609 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5610 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5611
5612 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5613 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5614
5615 See also : "option redispatch"
5616
5617
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005618rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005619 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5621 no | yes | yes | yes
5622 Arguments :
5623 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5624 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005625 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005626
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005627 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5628 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5629
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005630 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5631 the last header of an HTTP response.
5632
5633 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5634 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5635 responses.
5636
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005637 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5638 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005639
5640
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005641rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5642rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005643 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 no | yes | yes | yes
5646 Arguments :
5647 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5648 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5649 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5650 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5651 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5652 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5653 ignores case.
5654
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005655 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5656 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5657
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005658 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5659 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005660 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005661 client.
5662
5663 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5664 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5665 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5666
5667 Example :
5668 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005669 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005670
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005671 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5672 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005673
5674
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005675rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5676rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005677 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5679 no | yes | yes | yes
5680 Arguments :
5681 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5682 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5683 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5684 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5685 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5686 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5687 ignores case.
5688
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005689 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5690 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5691
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005692 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5693 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5694 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5695 case-sensitive.
5696
5697 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005698 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5699 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5700 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005701
5702 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5703 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5704
5705 Example :
5706 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5707 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5708
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005709 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5710 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005711
5712
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005713rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5714rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005715 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5717 no | yes | yes | yes
5718 Arguments :
5719 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5720 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5721 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5722 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5723 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5724 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5725 ignores case.
5726
5727 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5728 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5729 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5730 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005731 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005732
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005733 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5734 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5735
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005736 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5737 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5738 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5739
5740 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5741 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5742 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5743 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5744 are not case-sensitive.
5745
5746 Example :
5747 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5748 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5749
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005750 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5751 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005752
5753
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005754server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005755 Declare a server in a backend
5756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5757 no | no | yes | yes
5758 Arguments :
5759 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005760 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005761 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005762
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005763 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5764 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5765 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5766 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005767 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5768 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5769 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5770 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5771 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005772 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5773 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5774 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5775 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5776 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5777 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5778 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005779 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5780 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5781 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5782 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005784 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005785 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5786 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5787 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5788 adding this value to the client's port.
5789
5790 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5791 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005792 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005793
5794 Examples :
5795 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5796 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005797 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005798 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5799 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5800 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005801
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005802 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5803 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005804
5805
5806source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005807source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005808source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005809 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5811 yes | no | yes | yes
5812 Arguments :
5813 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5814 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005815
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005816 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005817 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5818 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5819 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5820 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5821 supported prefixes are :
5822 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5823 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5824 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005825 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5826 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5827 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5828 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005829
5830 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5831 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005832 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5833 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5834 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005835
5836 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5837 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5838 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5839 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5840 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5841 <addr>.
5842
5843 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5844 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5845 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5846 port.
5847
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005848 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5849 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5850 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5851 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005852 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005853 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5854 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5855 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5856 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5857 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5858 HTTP header.
5859
5860 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5861 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005862 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005863 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5864 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5865 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5866 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5867 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5868 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5869 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5870
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005871 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5872 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5873 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5874 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5875 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5876 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5877
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005878 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5879 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5880 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5881 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5882
5883 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5884 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5885 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5886 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5887 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5888 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5889
5890 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5891 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5892 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5893 there are two methods :
5894
5895 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5896 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5897 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5898 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5899 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5900 of the client ranges may be used.
5901
5902 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5903 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5904 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5905 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5906 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5907 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5908 same session.
5909
5910 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5911 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5912 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5913 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5914 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5915 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5916
5917 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5918 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5919 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005920 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005921
5922 Examples :
5923 backend private
5924 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5925 source 192.168.1.200
5926
5927 backend transparent_ssl1
5928 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5929 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5930
5931 backend transparent_ssl2
5932 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5933 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5934 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5935
5936 backend transparent_ssl3
5937 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5938 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5939 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5940
5941 backend transparent_smtp
5942 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5943 # with Tproxy version 4.
5944 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5945
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005946 backend transparent_http
5947 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5948 # proxy.
5949 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005951 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005952 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005954
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005955srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5956 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5958 yes | no | yes | yes
5959 Arguments :
5960 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5961 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5962 as explained at the top of this document.
5963
5964 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5965 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5966 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5967 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5968 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5969 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5970 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5971
5972 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5973 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5974 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5975 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5976 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005977 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005978 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005979 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005980
5981 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5982 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5983 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5984 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5985 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5986 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5987
5988 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5989 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5990
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005991 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5992 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005993
5994
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005995stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5996 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5998 no | no | yes | yes
5999
6000 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6001 matched.
6002
6003 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6004 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6005
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006006 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6007 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6008 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6009
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006010 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6011 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6012 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6013 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006014
6015 Example :
6016 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6017 backend stats_localhost
6018 stats enable
6019 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6020
6021 Example :
6022 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6023 backend stats_auth
6024 stats enable
6025 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6026 stats admin if TRUE
6027
6028 Example :
6029 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6030 userlist stats-auth
6031 group admin users admin
6032 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6033 group readonly users haproxy
6034 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6035
6036 backend stats_auth
6037 stats enable
6038 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6039 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6040 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6041 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6042
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006043 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6044 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6045 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006046
6047
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006048stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6049 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6051 yes | no | yes | yes
6052 Arguments :
6053 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6054
6055 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6056
6057 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6058 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6059 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6060 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6061 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6062 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6063
6064 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6065 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6066 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006067 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006068
6069 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6070 report using "stats scope".
6071
6072 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6073 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6074 unobvious parameters.
6075
6076 Example :
6077 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6078 backend public_www
6079 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6080 stats enable
6081 stats hide-version
6082 stats scope .
6083 stats uri /admin?stats
6084 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6085 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6086 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6087
6088 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6089 backend private_monitoring
6090 stats enable
6091 stats uri /admin?stats
6092 stats refresh 5s
6093
6094 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6095
6096
6097stats enable
6098 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6100 yes | no | yes | yes
6101 Arguments : none
6102
6103 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6104 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6105 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6106 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6107 - stats auth : no authentication
6108 - stats scope : no restriction
6109
6110 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6111 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6112 unobvious parameters.
6113
6114 Example :
6115 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6116 backend public_www
6117 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6118 stats enable
6119 stats hide-version
6120 stats scope .
6121 stats uri /admin?stats
6122 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6123 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6124 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6125
6126 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6127 backend private_monitoring
6128 stats enable
6129 stats uri /admin?stats
6130 stats refresh 5s
6131
6132 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6133
6134
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006135stats hide-version
6136 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006139 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006140
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006141 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6142 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6143 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6144 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6145 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6146 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006148 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6149 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6150 unobvious parameters.
6151
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006152 Example :
6153 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6154 backend public_www
6155 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006156 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006157 stats hide-version
6158 stats scope .
6159 stats uri /admin?stats
6160 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6161 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6162 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006163
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006164 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6165 backend private_monitoring
6166 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006167 stats uri /admin?stats
6168 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006169
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006170 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006171
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006172
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006173stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6174 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6175 Access control for statistics
6176
6177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6178 no | no | yes | yes
6179
6180 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6181 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6182 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6183 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6184 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6185 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6186
6187 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6188 instance.
6189
6190 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6191 about ACL usage.
6192
6193
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006194stats realm <realm>
6195 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 yes | no | yes | yes
6198 Arguments :
6199 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6200 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6201 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6202
6203 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6204 using a backslash ('\').
6205
6206 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6207 only related to authentication.
6208
6209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6211 unobvious parameters.
6212
6213 Example :
6214 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6215 backend public_www
6216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6217 stats enable
6218 stats hide-version
6219 stats scope .
6220 stats uri /admin?stats
6221 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6222 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6223 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6224
6225 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6226 backend private_monitoring
6227 stats enable
6228 stats uri /admin?stats
6229 stats refresh 5s
6230
6231 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6232
6233
6234stats refresh <delay>
6235 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6237 yes | no | yes | yes
6238 Arguments :
6239 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6240 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6241 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6242 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6243 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6244 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6245
6246 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6247 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6248 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6249 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6250
6251 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6252 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6253 unobvious parameters.
6254
6255 Example :
6256 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6257 backend public_www
6258 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6259 stats enable
6260 stats hide-version
6261 stats scope .
6262 stats uri /admin?stats
6263 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6264 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6265 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6266
6267 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6268 backend private_monitoring
6269 stats enable
6270 stats uri /admin?stats
6271 stats refresh 5s
6272
6273 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6274
6275
6276stats scope { <name> | "." }
6277 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 yes | no | yes | yes
6280 Arguments :
6281 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6282 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6283 section in which the statement appears.
6284
6285 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6286 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6287 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6288 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6289 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6290 exists.
6291
6292 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6293 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6294 unobvious parameters.
6295
6296 Example :
6297 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6298 backend public_www
6299 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6300 stats enable
6301 stats hide-version
6302 stats scope .
6303 stats uri /admin?stats
6304 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6305 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6306 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6307
6308 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6309 backend private_monitoring
6310 stats enable
6311 stats uri /admin?stats
6312 stats refresh 5s
6313
6314 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6315
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006316
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006317stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006318 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6320 yes | no | yes | yes
6321
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006322 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006323 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6324
6325 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6326 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6327
6328 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6329 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006330 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006331
6332 Example :
6333 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6334 backend private_monitoring
6335 stats enable
6336 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6337 stats uri /admin?stats
6338 stats refresh 5s
6339
6340 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6341 global section.
6342
6343
6344stats show-legends
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006345 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006346 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6347 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6348 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6349 - IP (socket, server)
6350 - cookie (backend, server)
6351
6352 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6353 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006354 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006355
6356 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6357
6358
6359stats show-node [ <name> ]
6360 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6362 yes | no | yes | yes
6363 Arguments:
6364 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6365 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6366
6367 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6368 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006369 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006370
6371 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6372 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6373 unobvious parameters.
6374
6375 Example:
6376 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6377 backend private_monitoring
6378 stats enable
6379 stats show-node Europe-1
6380 stats uri /admin?stats
6381 stats refresh 5s
6382
6383 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6384 section.
6385
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006386
6387stats uri <prefix>
6388 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6390 yes | no | yes | yes
6391 Arguments :
6392 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6393 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6394 query string.
6395
6396 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6397 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6398 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6399 possible to reach it in the application.
6400
6401 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006402 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006403 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6404 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6405 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6406 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6407
6408 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6409 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6410 an address or a port to statistics only.
6411
6412 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6413 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6414 unobvious parameters.
6415
6416 Example :
6417 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6418 backend public_www
6419 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6420 stats enable
6421 stats hide-version
6422 stats scope .
6423 stats uri /admin?stats
6424 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6425 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6426 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6427
6428 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6429 backend private_monitoring
6430 stats enable
6431 stats uri /admin?stats
6432 stats refresh 5s
6433
6434 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6435
6436
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006437stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6438 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006440 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006441
6442 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006443 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006444 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6445 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6446 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6447
6448 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6449 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6450 the "stick-table" statement.
6451
6452 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6453 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6454 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6455 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6456 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6457
6458 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6459 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6460 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6461 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6462 transformation rules.
6463
6464 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6465 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6466 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6467 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6468 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6469 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6470 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6471
6472 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6473 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6474 ACL based conditions.
6475
6476 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6477 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6478 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6479 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6480
6481 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6482 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6483 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6484 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6485
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006486 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6487 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6488 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6489
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006490 Example :
6491 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6492 # last 30 minutes
6493 backend pop
6494 mode tcp
6495 balance roundrobin
6496 stick store-request src
6497 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6498 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6499 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6500
6501 backend smtp
6502 mode tcp
6503 balance roundrobin
6504 stick match src table pop
6505 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6506 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6507
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006508 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6509 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006510
6511
6512stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6513 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 no | no | yes | yes
6516
6517 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6518 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6519 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6520 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6521
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006522 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6523 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6524 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6525
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006526 Examples :
6527 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006528 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006529
6530 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6531 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6532 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6533
6534
6535 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6536 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6537 backend http
6538 mode http
6539 balance roundrobin
6540 stick on src table https
6541 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6542 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6543 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6544
6545 backend https
6546 mode tcp
6547 balance roundrobin
6548 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6549 stick on src
6550 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6551 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6552
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006553 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006554
6555
6556stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6557 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 no | no | yes | yes
6560
6561 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006562 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006563 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6564 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6565 server is selected.
6566
6567 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6568 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6569 the "stick-table" statement.
6570
6571 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6572 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6573 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6574 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6575 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6576 address.
6577
6578 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6579 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6580 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6581 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6582 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6583 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6584 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6585 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6586 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6587 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6588
6589 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6590 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6591 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6592 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6593 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6594 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6595 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6596
6597 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6598 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6599 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6600 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6601
6602 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6603 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6604 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6605 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6606 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6607 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006608 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6609 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6610 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6611 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6612 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6613 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006614
6615 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6616 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6617 the request.
6618
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006619 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6620 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6621 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6622
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006623 Example :
6624 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6625 # last 30 minutes
6626 backend pop
6627 mode tcp
6628 balance roundrobin
6629 stick store-request src
6630 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6631 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6632 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6633
6634 backend smtp
6635 mode tcp
6636 balance roundrobin
6637 stick match src table pop
6638 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6639 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6640
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006641 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6642 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006643
6644
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006645stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006646 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6647 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006648 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006650 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006651
6652 Arguments :
6653 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6654 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6655 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6656 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6657
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006658 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6659 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6660 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6661 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6662
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006663 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6664 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6665 instance.
6666
6667 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6668 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6669 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6670 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6671 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6672 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006673 to 32 characters.
6674
6675 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6676 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6677 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6678 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6679 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6680 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006681
6682 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006683 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6684 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006685 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6686 increase.
6687
6688 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006689 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6690 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6691 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006692
6693 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6694 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6695 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6696 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6697 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6698 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6699 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6700 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6701 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6702 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6703 parameter (see below).
6704
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006705 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6706 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6707 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6708 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6709 soft restart.
6710
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006711 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6712
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006713 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6714 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6715 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6716 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6717 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006718 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006719 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6720 if not expiration delay is specified.
6721
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006722 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6723 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6724 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6725 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006726 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6727 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6728 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6729 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6730 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6731 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6732 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6733 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6734 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6735 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6736 types and their arguments.
6737
6738 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6739 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6740 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6741 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6742
6743 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6744 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6745 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6746 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6747
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006748 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6749 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6750 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6751 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6752 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6753 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6754
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006755 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6756 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6757 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6758 they were received.
6759
6760 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6761 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6762 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6763 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6764 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6765
6766 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6767 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6768 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6769 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6770 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6771
6772 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6773 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6774 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6775
6776 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6777 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6778 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6779 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6780 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6781
6782 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6783 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6784 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6785 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6786 the client side.
6787
6788 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6789 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6790 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6791 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6792 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6793 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6794 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6795
6796 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6797 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6798 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6799 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6800 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6801 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6802 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6803
6804 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6805 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6806 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6807 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6808 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6809 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6810
6811 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6812 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6813 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6814 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6815
6816 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6817 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6818 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6819 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6820 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6821 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6822 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6823 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6824 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6825 recommended for better fairness.
6826
6827 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6828 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6829 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6830 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6831
6832 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6833 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6834 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6835 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6836 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6837 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6838 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6839 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6840 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6841 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006842
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006843 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6844 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006845 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6846 reference it.
6847
6848 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6849 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6850 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6851 as an exclusive stickiness.
6852
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006853 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6854 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6855 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6856 something that can be ignored.
6857
6858 Example:
6859 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6860 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6861 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6862 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6863
6864 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006865 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006866
6867
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006868stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6869 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6871 no | no | yes | yes
6872
6873 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006874 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006875 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6876 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6877 server is selected.
6878
6879 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6880 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6881 the "stick-table" statement.
6882
6883 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6884 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6885 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6886 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6887
6888 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6889 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6890 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6891 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6892 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6893 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006894 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006895 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6896 rules.
6897
6898 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6899 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6900 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6901 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6902 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6903 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6904 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6905
6906 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6907 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6908 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6909 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6910
6911 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6912 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6913 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6914 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6915 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6916 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006917 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6918 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6919 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6920 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6921 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6922 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6923 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6924 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6925 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006926
6927 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6928
6929 Example :
6930 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6931 backend https
6932 mode tcp
6933 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006934 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006935 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006936
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006937 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6938 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6939
6940 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6941 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6942 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6943
6944 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6945 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006946
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006947 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6948 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6949 # at offset 44.
6950
6951 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6952 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6953
6954 # Learn on response if server hello.
6955 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006956
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006957 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6958 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6959
6960 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6961 extraction.
6962
6963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006964tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6965 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006968 Arguments :
6969 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006970 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6971 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006973 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006974
6975 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6976 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006977 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6978 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6979 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6980 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6981 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6982 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006984 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6985 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6986 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6987 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006989 Three types of actions are supported :
6990 - accept :
6991 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6992 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6993 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006995 - reject :
6996 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6997 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6998 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6999 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7000 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7001 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7002 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7003 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7004 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7005 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7006 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7007 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007008
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007009 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7010 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7011 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7012 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7013 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7014 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7015 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7016 hosts.
7017
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007018 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007019 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7020 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7021 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007022 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7023 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007024 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007025 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7026 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7027 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7028 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7029 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007031 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007032 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007033 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007034 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7035 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7036 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7037 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007039 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7040 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7041 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7042 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007044 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7045 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7046 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7047 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7048 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007049 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7050 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7051 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7052 layer7 information is extracted.
7053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007054 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7055 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7056 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7057 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7058 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007060 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7061 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7062 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007064 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7065 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7066 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007068 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007069 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007070 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007072 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7073 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7074 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007076 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007077 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7078 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007079
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007080 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7081
7082 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7083
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007084 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007086 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007087
7088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007089tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7090 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007092 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007093 Arguments :
7094 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007095 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7096 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007097 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007099 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007101 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7102 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7103 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7104 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7105 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007107 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7108 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7109 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7110 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007111 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7112 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7113 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7114 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7115 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7116 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007117 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007118 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007120 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7121 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7122 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7123 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007125 Three types of actions are supported :
7126 - accept :
7127 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007128 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007130 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7131 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007132
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007133 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7134 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7135 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7136 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7137 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7138 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007139
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007140 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007141 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7142 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007144 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007145 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7146 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7147 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7148 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007149 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7150 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7151 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007152
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007153 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7154 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7155 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7156 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7157
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007158 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007159 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7160 # and reject everything else.
7161 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7162 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007163 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007164 tcp-request content reject
7165
7166 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007167 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7168 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7169 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007170 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007171
7172 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7173 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7174 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007175 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007176 tcp-request content reject
7177
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007178 Example:
7179 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7180 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007181 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007182
7183 Example:
7184 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7185 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007186 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007188 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7189 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7190
7191 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007192 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007193 # protecting all our sites
7194 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007195 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7196 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007197 ...
7198 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7199
7200 backend http_dynamic
7201 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007202 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007203 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007204 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7205 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7206 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007207 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007209 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007211 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007212
7213
7214tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7215 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007217 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007218 Arguments :
7219 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7221 as explained at the top of this document.
7222
7223 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7224 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7225 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7226 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7227 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7228
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007229 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7230 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7231 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7232 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7233
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007234 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7235 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007236 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007237 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007238 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7239 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7240 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7241 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007242
7243 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7244 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7245 it pass through unaffected.
7246
7247 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7248 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7249 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007250 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007251 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7252 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007253 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7254 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7255 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007256
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007257 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007258 "timeout client".
7259
7260
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007261tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7262 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7264 no | no | yes | yes
7265 Arguments :
7266 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007267 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007268
7269 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7270
7271 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7272 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7273 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007274 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7275 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007276
7277 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7278
7279 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7280 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7281 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7282 inserted.
7283
7284 Two types of actions are supported :
7285 - accept :
7286 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7287 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7288 the rules evaluation.
7289
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007290 - close :
7291 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7292 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7293 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7294 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7295 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7296 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007297 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007298 protocols.
7299
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007300 - reject :
7301 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7302 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007303 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007304
7305 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7306 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7307 for changing the default action to a reject.
7308
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007309 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7310 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7311 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7312 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007313 period.
7314
7315 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7316
7317 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7318
7319
7320tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7321 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7323 no | no | yes | yes
7324 Arguments :
7325 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7326 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7327 as explained at the top of this document.
7328
7329 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7330
7331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007332timeout check <timeout>
7333 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7334 established.
7335
7336 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | no | yes | yes
7338 Arguments:
7339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7341 as explained at the top of this document.
7342
7343 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7344 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7345 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7346 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007347 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7348 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7349 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007350
7351 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7352 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7353
7354 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7355 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007356 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007357
7358 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7359 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7360 forget about it.
7361
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007362 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7363 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007364
7365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007366timeout client <timeout>
7367timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7368 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7370 yes | yes | yes | no
7371 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007372 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007373 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7374 as explained at the top of this document.
7375
7376 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7377 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7378 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7379 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7380 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7381 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7382 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7383 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007384 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007385 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007386 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7387 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7388 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007389
7390 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7391 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7392 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7393 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7394 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7395 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7396
7397 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7398 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7399 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7400
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007401 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007402
7403
7404timeout connect <timeout>
7405timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7406 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 yes | no | yes | yes
7409 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007410 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007411 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7412 as explained at the top of this document.
7413
7414 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007415 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007416 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007417 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007418 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7419 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007420
7421 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7422 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7423 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7424 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7425 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7426 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7427
7428 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7429 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7430 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7431
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007432 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7433 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007434
7435
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007436timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7437 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7439 yes | yes | yes | yes
7440 Arguments :
7441 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7442 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7443 as explained at the top of this document.
7444
7445 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7446 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7447 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7448 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7449 once the request has started to present itself.
7450
7451 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7452 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7453 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7454 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7455 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7456
7457 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7458 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7459 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7460 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7461
7462 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7463 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7464 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7465 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7466 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007467 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007468
7469 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7470 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7471 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7472 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7473
7474 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7475
7476
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007477timeout http-request <timeout>
7478 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007480 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007481 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007482 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007483 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7484 as explained at the top of this document.
7485
7486 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7487 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7488 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7489 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7490 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7491 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7492 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7493 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7494
7495 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7496 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007497 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7498 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007499
7500 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7501 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7502 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7503 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7504 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7505
7506 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007507 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7508 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7509 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007510
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007511 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007512
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007513
7514timeout queue <timeout>
7515 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7517 yes | no | yes | yes
7518 Arguments :
7519 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7520 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7521 as explained at the top of this document.
7522
7523 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7524 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7525 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7526 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7527 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7528
7529 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7530 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7531 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7532 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7533
7534 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7535
7536
7537timeout server <timeout>
7538timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7539 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7541 yes | no | yes | yes
7542 Arguments :
7543 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7544 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7545 as explained at the top of this document.
7546
7547 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7548 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7549 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7550 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7551 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7552 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7553 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7554
7555 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7556 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7557 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7558 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7559 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007560 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007561 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007562 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7563 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7564 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7565 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007566
7567 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7568 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7569 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7570 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7571 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7572 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7573
7574 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7575 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7576 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7577
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007578 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007579
7580
7581timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007582 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 yes | yes | yes | yes
7585 Arguments :
7586 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7587 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7588 as explained at the top of this document.
7589
7590 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7591 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7592 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7593
7594 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7595 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7596 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7597 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007598 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007599
7600 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7601
7602
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007603timeout tunnel <timeout>
7604 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | no | yes | yes
7607 Arguments :
7608 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7609 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7610 as explained at the top of this document.
7611
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007612 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007613 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7614 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7615 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7616 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7617 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7618 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7619 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7620 specified.
7621
7622 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7623 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7624 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7625 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7626 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7627
7628 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7629 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7630 forget about it.
7631
7632 Example :
7633 defaults http
7634 option http-server-close
7635 timeout connect 5s
7636 timeout client 30s
7637 timeout client 30s
7638 timeout server 30s
7639 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7640
7641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7642
7643
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007644transparent (deprecated)
7645 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007647 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007648 Arguments : none
7649
7650 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7651 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7652 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7653 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7654 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7655 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7656 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7657 appropriate server.
7658
7659 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7660
7661 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7662 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7663
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007664 See also: "option transparent"
7665
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007666unique-id-format <string>
7667 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7669 yes | yes | yes | no
7670 Arguments :
7671 <string> is a log-format string.
7672
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007673 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7674 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7675 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7676 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007677
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007678 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7679 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7680 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7681 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7682 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7683 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7684 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7685 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007686
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007687 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7688 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007689
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007690 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007691
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007692 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007693
7694 will generate:
7695
7696 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7697
7698 See also: "unique-id-header"
7699
7700unique-id-header <name>
7701 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7703 yes | yes | yes | no
7704 Arguments :
7705 <name> is the name of the header.
7706
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007707 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7708 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007709
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007710 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007711
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007712 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007713 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7714
7715 will generate:
7716
7717 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7718
7719 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007720
7721use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7722use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007723 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7725 no | yes | yes | no
7726 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007727 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7728 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007730 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007731
7732 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7733 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7734 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007735 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7736 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7737 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7738 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007739
7740 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7741 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7742 assign the backend.
7743
7744 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7745 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7746 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7747 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7748 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7749 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7750
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007751 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007752 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007753 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7754 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7755 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7756
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007757 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7758 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7759 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7760 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7761 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7762 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7763 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7764 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7765 cannot be forced from the request.
7766
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007767 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007768 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7769 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7770
7771 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7772 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007773
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007774
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007775use-server <server> if <condition>
7776use-server <server> unless <condition>
7777 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 no | no | yes | yes
7780 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007781 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007782
7783 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7784
7785 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7786 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7787 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7788
7789 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7790 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7791 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7792 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7793 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7794 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7795 matches will assign the server.
7796
7797 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7798 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7799 with the next rules until one matches.
7800
7801 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7802 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7803 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7804 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7805
7806 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7807 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7808 stripped.
7809
7810 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7811 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7812 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7813 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7814
7815 Example :
7816 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7817 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7818 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7819 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7820 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7821 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7822 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7823 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7824 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7825
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007826 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007827
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007828
78295. Bind and Server options
7830--------------------------
7831
7832The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7833depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7834settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7835written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7836described in this section.
7837
7838
78395.1. Bind options
7840-----------------
7841
7842The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7843as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7844no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7845parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7846while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7847provided immediately after the setting name.
7848
7849The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7850
7851accept-proxy
7852 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7853 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7854 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7855 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7856 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7857 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7858 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7859 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7860 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007861 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7862 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007863
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007864alpn <protocols>
7865 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7866 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7867 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7868 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7869 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7870 initial NPN extension.
7871
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007872backlog <backlog>
7873 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7874 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7875
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007876ecdhe <named curve>
7877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007878 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7879 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007880
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007881ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7883 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7884 client's certificate.
7885
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007886ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7888 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7889 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7890 error is ignored.
7891
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007892ciphers <ciphers>
7893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7894 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007895 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007896 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7897 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7898
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007899crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7901 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7902 to verify client's certificate.
7903
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007904crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7906 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7907 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7908 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7909 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7910 file.
7911
7912 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7913 are loaded.
7914
7915 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7916 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7917 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7918 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7919 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7920 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7921 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7922 www.sub.example.org).
7923
7924 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7925 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7926 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7927 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7928 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7929
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007930 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007931
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007932 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7933 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08007934 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007935 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7936 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7937 clients).
7938
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007939crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7941 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007942 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007943 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007944
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007945crt-list <file>
7946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007947 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7948 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007949
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007950 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007951
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007952 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7953 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7954 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7955 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7956 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7957 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7958 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7959 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007960
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007961defer-accept
7962 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7963 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7964 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7965 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7966 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7967 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7968 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7969 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7970 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7971 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7972 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7973
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007974force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007975 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007976 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7977 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7978
7979force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007980 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007981 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7982
7983force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007984 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007985 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7986
7987force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007988 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007989 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7990
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007991gid <gid>
7992 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7993 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7994 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7995 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7996 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7997
7998group <group>
7999 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8000 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8001 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8002 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8003 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8004
8005id <id>
8006 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8007 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8008 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8009 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8010
8011interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008012 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8013 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8014 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8015 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8016 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8017 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8018 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008019
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008020level <level>
8021 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8022 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8023 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8024 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8025 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8026 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8027 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8028 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8029 counters).
8030 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8031 all counters).
8032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008033maxconn <maxconn>
8034 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8035 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8036 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8037 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8038 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8039 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8040 eat all memory.
8041
8042mode <mode>
8043 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8044 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8045 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8046 UNIX sockets.
8047
8048mss <maxseg>
8049 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8050 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8051 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8052 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8053 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8054 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8055 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8056 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8057 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8058 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8059 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8060
8061name <name>
8062 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8063 page.
8064
8065nice <nice>
8066 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8067 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8068 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8069 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8070 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8071 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8072 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8073 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8074 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8075 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8076 one for an RDP socket.
8077
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008078no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008080 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008081 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008082 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8083 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008084
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008085no-tls-tickets
8086 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8087 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8088 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8089 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8090
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008091no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008093 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008094 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8095 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8096 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008097
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008098no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008100 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008101 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8102 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8103 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008104
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008105no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008107 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008108 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8109 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8110 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008111
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008112npn <protocols>
8113 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8114 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8115 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8116 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008117 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8118 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008120ssl
8121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008122 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008123 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8124 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8125 to deciphered contents.
8126
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008127strict-sni
8128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8129 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8130 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8131 See the "crt" option for more information.
8132
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008133tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008134 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008135 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8136 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8137 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8138 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8139 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8140 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8141 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008142 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8143 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8144 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008146transparent
8147 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8148 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8149 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8150 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8151 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8152 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8153 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8154 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8155 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8156 so check for support with your vendor.
8157
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008158v4v6
8159 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8160 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8161 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8162 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008163 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008164
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008165v6only
8166 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8167 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8168 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008169 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8170 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008171
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008172uid <uid>
8173 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8174 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8175 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8176 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8177 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8178
8179user <user>
8180 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8181 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8182 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8183 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8184 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8185
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008186verify [none|optional|required]
8187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8188 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8189 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8190 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8191 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008192 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8193 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8194 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8195 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008196
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020081975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008198------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008200The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8201which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8202arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8203settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8204after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8205Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8206address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008208 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008209 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008211The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008212
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008213addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008214 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8215 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8216 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8217 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8218 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008220 Supported in default-server: No
8221
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008222agent-check
8223 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8224 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8225 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8226 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8227
8228 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8229 e.g. "75%"
8230
8231 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8232 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8233
8234 * The string "drain".
8235
8236 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8237 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8238 persistence.
8239
8240 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8241
8242 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8243
8244 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8245
8246 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8247
8248 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8249
8250 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8251
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008252 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8253 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8254 parameter.
8255
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008256 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8257 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8258
8259 Supported in default-server: No
8260
8261agent-inter <delay>
8262 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8263 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8264
8265 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8266 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8267 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8268 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8269 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8270 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8271 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8272 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8273 of backends use the same servers.
8274
8275 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8276
8277 Supported in default-server: Yes
8278
8279agent-port <port>
8280 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8281
8282 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8283
8284 Supported in default-server: Yes
8285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008286backup
8287 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8288 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8289 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8290 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8291 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8292 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008294 Supported in default-server: No
8295
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008296ca-file <cafile>
8297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8298 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8299 server's certificate.
8300
8301 Supported in default-server: No
8302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008303check
8304 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008305 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8306 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8307 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8308 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8309 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8310 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8311 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008312 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8313 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8314 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008316 Supported in default-server: No
8317
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008318check-send-proxy
8319 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8320 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8321 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8322 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8323 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8324 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8325 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8326
8327 Supported in default-server: No
8328
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008329check-ssl
8330 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8331 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8332 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8333 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008334 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008335 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8336 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8337 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8338 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8339
8340 Supported in default-server: No
8341
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008342ciphers <ciphers>
8343 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008344 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008345 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8346 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8347 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8348 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8349 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8350 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8351
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008352 Supported in default-server: No
8353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008354cookie <value>
8355 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8356 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8357 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8358 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8359 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8360 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8361 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008363 Supported in default-server: No
8364
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008365crl-file <crlfile>
8366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8367 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8368 to verify server's certificate.
8369
8370 Supported in default-server: No
8371
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008372crt <cert>
8373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8374 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8375 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8376 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8377 certificate request.
8378
8379 Supported in default-server: No
8380
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008381disabled
8382 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8383 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8384 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8385 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8386 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8387
8388 Supported in default-server: No
8389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008390error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008391 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8392 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8393 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008395 Supported in default-server: Yes
8396
8397 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008399fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008400 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8401 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8402 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008404 Supported in default-server: Yes
8405
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008406force-sslv3
8407 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8408 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8409 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8410
8411 Supported in default-server: No
8412
8413force-tlsv10
8414 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8415 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8416
8417 Supported in default-server: No
8418
8419force-tlsv11
8420 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8421 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8422
8423 Supported in default-server: No
8424
8425force-tlsv12
8426 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8427 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8428
8429 Supported in default-server: No
8430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008431id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008432 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8433 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8434 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008436 Supported in default-server: No
8437
8438inter <delay>
8439fastinter <delay>
8440downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008441 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8442 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8443 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8444 between checks depending on the server state :
8445
8446 Server state | Interval used
8447 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8448 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8449 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8450 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8451 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8452 or yet unchecked. |
8453 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8454 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8455 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008457 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8458 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8459 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8460 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008461 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8462 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8463 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8464 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8465 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008467 Supported in default-server: Yes
8468
8469maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008470 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8471 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8472 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8473 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8474 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8475 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8476 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8477 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008479 Supported in default-server: Yes
8480
8481maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008482 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8483 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8484 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8485 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8486 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8487 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8488 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008490 Supported in default-server: Yes
8491
8492minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008493 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8494 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8495 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8496 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8497 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8498 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008499 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008500 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008502 Supported in default-server: Yes
8503
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008504no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008505 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8506 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008507 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008508
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008509 Supported in default-server: No
8510
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008511no-tls-tickets
8512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8513 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8514 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8515 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8516
8517 Supported in default-server: No
8518
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008519no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008520 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008521 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8522 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008523 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8524 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008525
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008526 Supported in default-server: No
8527
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008528no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008529 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008530 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8531 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008532 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8533 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008534
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008535 Supported in default-server: No
8536
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008537no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008538 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008539 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8540 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008541 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8542 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008543
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008544 Supported in default-server: No
8545
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008546non-stick
8547 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8548 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8549 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8550
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008551 Supported in default-server: No
8552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008553observe <mode>
8554 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8555 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8556 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8557 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8558 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8559 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008560 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008562 Supported in default-server: No
8563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008564 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008566on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008567 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8568 Currently, four modes are available:
8569 - fastinter: force fastinter
8570 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8571 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8572 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8573 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008575 Supported in default-server: Yes
8576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008577 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8578
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008579on-marked-down <action>
8580 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8581 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008582 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8583 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8584 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8585 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8586 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8587 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8588 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8589 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008590
8591 Actions are disabled by default
8592
8593 Supported in default-server: Yes
8594
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008595on-marked-up <action>
8596 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8597 Currently one action is available:
8598 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8599 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8600 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8601 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8602 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8603 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8604 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8605 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8606
8607 Actions are disabled by default
8608
8609 Supported in default-server: Yes
8610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008611port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008612 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8613 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8614 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8615 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8616 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8617 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008619 Supported in default-server: Yes
8620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008621redir <prefix>
8622 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8623 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8624 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8625 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8626 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8627 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8628 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8629 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008630 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008631 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8632 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8633 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8634 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8635 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8636
8637 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008639 Supported in default-server: No
8640
8641rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008642 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8643 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8644 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008646 Supported in default-server: Yes
8647
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008648send-proxy
8649 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8650 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8651 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8652 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8653 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8654 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8655 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8656 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8657 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008658 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8659 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8660 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8661 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8662 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008663
8664 Supported in default-server: No
8665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008666slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008667 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8668 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8669 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8670 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8671 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8672 parameters :
8673
8674 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8675 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8676
8677 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8678 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8679 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8680 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8681
8682 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8683 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8684 seen as failed.
8685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008686 Supported in default-server: Yes
8687
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008688source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008689source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008690source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008691 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8692 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8693 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8694 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8695
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008696 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8697 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8698 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8699 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8700 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8701 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8702 server.
8703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008704 Supported in default-server: No
8705
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008706ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008707 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8708 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8709 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8710 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8711 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8712 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008713 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008714
8715 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008717track [<proxy>/]<server>
8718 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8719 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8720 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8721 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8722 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008724 Supported in default-server: No
8725
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008726verify [none|required]
8727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008728 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8729 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8730 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8731 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008732 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8733 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8734 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008735
8736 Supported in default-server: No
8737
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008738verifyhost <hostname>
8739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8740 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8741 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8742 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8743 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8744 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8745
8746 Supported in default-server: No
8747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008748weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008749 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8750 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8751 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008752 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8753 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8754 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8755 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8756 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8757 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008759 Supported in default-server: Yes
8760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008761
87626. HTTP header manipulation
8763---------------------------
8764
8765In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8766response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8767request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8768which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008769against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008770
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008771If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8772to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8773but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8774HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8775stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8776because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8777a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8778still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008780This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8781in section 4.2 :
8782
8783 - reqadd <string>
8784 - reqallow <search>
8785 - reqiallow <search>
8786 - reqdel <search>
8787 - reqidel <search>
8788 - reqdeny <search>
8789 - reqideny <search>
8790 - reqpass <search>
8791 - reqipass <search>
8792 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8793 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8794 - reqtarpit <search>
8795 - reqitarpit <search>
8796 - rspadd <string>
8797 - rspdel <search>
8798 - rspidel <search>
8799 - rspdeny <search>
8800 - rspideny <search>
8801 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8802 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8803
8804With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8805is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8806parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8807prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8808Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8809
8810 \t for a tab
8811 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8812 \n for a new line (LF)
8813 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8814 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8815 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8816 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8817 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8818
8819The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8820portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8821above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8822regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
88239 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8824is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8825
8826The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8827after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8828
8829Notes related to these keywords :
8830---------------------------------
8831 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8832 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8833 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8834
8835 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8836 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8837 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8838
8839 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8840 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8841 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8842 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8843 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8844
8845 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8846 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8847 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8848 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8849 useless headers before adding new ones.
8850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008851 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008852 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8853
8854 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8855 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8856 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8857
8858 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8859 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008860 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008861
8862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088637. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8864----------------------------------
8865
8866Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8867client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8868The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8869these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8870but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8871data called patterns.
8872
8873
88747.1. ACL basics
8875---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008876
8877The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8878content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8879from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8880simple :
8881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008882 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008883 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008884 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8885 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008887The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8888adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008889
8890In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008892 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008893
8894This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8895Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8896and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008897an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8898conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8899as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8900are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008901
8902ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8903'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8904which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8905
8906There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8907performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008909The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8910specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8911this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008912methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8913ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008914
8915Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8916 - boolean
8917 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8918 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8919 - string
8920 - data block
8921
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008922Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8923converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8924would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8925The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8926which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008928The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8929 - boolean
8930 - integer or integer range
8931 - IP address / network
8932 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8933 - regular expression
8934 - hex block
8935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008936The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8937
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008938 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8939 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008940 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008941 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008942 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008943 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008944 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008946The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8947read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8948if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8949lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8950will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8951beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8952a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8953lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8954exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8955
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008956The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
8957parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
8958ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
8959a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
8960check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
8961
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008962The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
8963socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
8964file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
8965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008966Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8967loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8968
8969 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8970
8971In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8972the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8973case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8974as well.
8975
8976The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8977sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8978do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8979methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8980is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8981obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8982followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8983default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8984that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8985string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8986
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008987The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
8988By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
8989string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
8990resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
8991server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
8992waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
8993flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
8994function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
8995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008996There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8997sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8998be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008999
9000 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9001 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009002 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9003 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9004 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9005 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009006
9007 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9008 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009009 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009010
9011 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009012 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009013
9014 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009015 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009016
9017 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9018 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9019
9020 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9021 binary or string samples.
9022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009023 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9024 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009026 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9027 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9028 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009030 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9031 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009033 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9034 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009036 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9037 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009039 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9040 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009041 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009043 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9044 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9045 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009046
9047For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9048request, it is possible to do :
9049
9050 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9051
9052In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9053buffer, one would use the following acl :
9054
9055 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9056
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009057On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9058possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9059
9060 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009062All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9063criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9064method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9065to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9066criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9067the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009069If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009070the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9071For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009073 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9074 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9075 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9076 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009077
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009078
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009079The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009080and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9081combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9082the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009084 +-------------------------------------------------+
9085 | Input sample type |
9086 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9087 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9088 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9089 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9090 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009091 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009092 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009093 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009094 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009095 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009096 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009097 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009098 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009099 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009100 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009101 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009102 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009103 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009104 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009105 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009106 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009107 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009108 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009109 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009110 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009111 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009112 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9113 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9114 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009115
9116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091177.1.1. Matching booleans
9118------------------------
9119
9120In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9121Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9122When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9123that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9124
9125Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9126return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9127"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9128
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091307.1.2. Matching integers
9131------------------------
9132
9133Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9134enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9135to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9136
9137Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9138matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9139lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009140
9141For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9142unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9143representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9144
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009145As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9146two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9147instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9148ranges and operators.
9149
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009150For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009151operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9152Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9153of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009155Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009156
9157 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9158 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9159 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9160 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9161 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009163For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009164
9165 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9166
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009167This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9168
9169 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9170
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091727.1.3. Matching strings
9173-----------------------
9174
9175String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9176different forms :
9177
9178 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9179 patterns ;
9180
9181 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9182 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9183
9184 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9185 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9186
9187 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9188 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9189
9190 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9191 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9192 matches.
9193
9194 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9195 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9196 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009197
9198String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9199exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9200characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9201string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9202to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009203before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009204
9205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092067.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9207---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009208
9209Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9210they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9211possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9212passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9213the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009214the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9215match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009216
9217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092187.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9219-------------------------------------
9220
9221It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9222not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9223a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9224to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9225digits may be used upper or lower case.
9226
9227Example :
9228 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9229 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9230
9231
92327.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9233---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009234
9235IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9236netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9237within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009238host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009239difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9240at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9241does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9242parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009243
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009244IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9245Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9246trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9247IPv6 patterns.
9248
9249HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9250following situations :
9251 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9252 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9253 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9254 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9255 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9256 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9257 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9258 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9259 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9260 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009262
92637.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9264----------------------------------
9265
9266Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9267combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9268
9269 - AND (implicit)
9270 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9271 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009273A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009275 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009277Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9278indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009280For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9281"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9282requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9283is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9284
9285 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9286 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9287 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9288 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9289
9290To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9291and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9292
9293 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9294 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9295 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9296 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9297
9298 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9299 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9300 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9301 use_backend www if host_www
9302
9303It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9304expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9305be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9306the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9307
9308 The following rule :
9309
9310 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9311 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9312
9313 Can also be written that way :
9314
9315 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9316
9317It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9318to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9319simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9320sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9321good use is the following :
9322
9323 With named ACLs :
9324
9325 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9326 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9327 monitor fail if site_dead
9328
9329 With anonymous ACLs :
9330
9331 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9332
9333See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9334
9335
93367.3. Fetching samples
9337---------------------
9338
9339Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9340against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9341sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9342ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9343of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9344available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9345
9346This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9347Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9348compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9349deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9350
9351The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9352matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9353method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9354indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9355
9356As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9357when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9358mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9359the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9360ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9361
9362Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9363multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9364when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9365incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9366are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9367is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9368all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9369
9370Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9371 - name
9372 - name(arg1)
9373 - name(arg1,arg2)
9374
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009375Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9376of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9377is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9378was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9379has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9380unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9381
9382These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9383sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9384the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9385support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009387The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009389 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9390 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9391 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009393 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9394 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9395 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009396
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009397 hex Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two
9398 hex digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex
9399 dumps of some binary input data in a way that can be reliably
9400 transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009402 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9403 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9404 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9405 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9406 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9407
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009408 http_date([<offset>])
9409 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9410 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9411 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9412 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9413 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9414 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9415 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9416 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009417
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009418 language(<value[;value[;value[;...]]]>[,<default>])
9419 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as
9420 extracted from the "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr".
9421 Values with no q-factor have a q-factor of 1. Values with a
9422 q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which belong to the
9423 list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. If
9424 no value matches the given list and a default value is
9425 provided, it is returned. Note that language names may have
9426 a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in
9427 the list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base
9428 language is checked. The match is case-sensitive, and the
9429 output string is always one of those provided in arguments.
9430 The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the ordering
9431 of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9432 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
9433
9434 Example :
9435
Thierry FOURNIER45ad91e2014-04-16 11:10:53 +02009436 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9437 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009438
Thierry FOURNIER45ad91e2014-04-16 11:10:53 +02009439 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9440 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9441 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9442 use_backend spanish if es
9443 use_backend french if fr
9444 use_backend english if en
9445 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009446
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009447 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9448 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9449 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9450 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9451 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9452 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9453 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9454 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9455 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9456 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9457 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9458 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9459 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9460 the map* converters.
9461
9462 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9463 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9464 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9465 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9466
9467 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9468 | `-_ out | | | |
9469 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9470 | / match `-_ | | | |
9471 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9472 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9473 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9474 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9475 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9476 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9477 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9478 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9479 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9480 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9481
9482 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9483 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9484 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9485 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9486 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9487 trailing spaces/tabs.
9488
9489 Example :
9490
9491 # this is a comment and is ignored
9492 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9493 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9494 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9495 | | | `----------- value
9496 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9497 | `---------------------------- key
9498 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095007.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9501--------------------------------------------
9502
9503A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9504not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9505"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9506The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9507
9508always_false : boolean
9509 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9510 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9511
9512always_true : boolean
9513 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9514 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9515
9516avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009517 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009518 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9519 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9520 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9521 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9522 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9523 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9524 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9525 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9526 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9527 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9528 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9529 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9530 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009532be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009533 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9534 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9535 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9536 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9537 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009539be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9540 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9541 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9542 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9543 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9544 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9545 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009546
9547 Example :
9548 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9549 backend dynamic
9550 mode http
9551 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9552 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009554connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9555 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009556 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009557 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9558 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009559
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009560 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009561 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009562 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9563
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009564 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9565 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009566
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009567 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009568 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009569 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009570 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9571 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009572 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009573 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009574
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009575 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9576 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009577 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009578 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009579
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009580date([<offset>]) : integer
9581 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9582 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9583 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9584 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009585 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9586
9587 Example :
9588
9589 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9590 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009591
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009592env(<name>) : string
9593 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9594 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9595 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9596 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9597 certain way.
9598
9599 Examples :
9600 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9601 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9602
9603 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9604 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009606fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9607 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009608 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9609 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009610 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9611 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9612 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9613 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9614 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009616fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9618 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9619 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9620 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9621 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9622 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9623 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9624 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009625
9626 Example :
9627 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9628 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9629 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9630 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9631 frontend mail
9632 bind :25
9633 mode tcp
9634 maxconn 100
9635 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9636 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9637 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9638 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009640nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9641 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9642 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9643 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009644 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9645 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9646 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009648queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009649 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9650 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9651 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009652 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9653 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9654 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9655 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9656 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9657
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009658rand([<range>]) : integer
9659 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9660 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9661 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9662 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9663 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009665srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9666 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9667 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9668 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9669 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9670 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9671 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9672 methods.
9673
9674srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9675 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9676 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9677 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9678 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9679 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9680 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9681 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9682
9683srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9684 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9685 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009686 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009687 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9688 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9689 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9690 overloading servers).
9691
9692 Example :
9693 # Redirect to a separate back
9694 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9695 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9696 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9697
9698table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9699 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9700 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9701
9702table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9703 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9704 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9705 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9706
9707
97087.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9709----------------------------------
9710
9711The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9712closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9713methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9714sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9715TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009716the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9717counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9718"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009719argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9720the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9721this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009722
9723be_id : integer
9724 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9725 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9726
9727dst : ip
9728 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9729 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9730 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9731 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9732 RFC 4291.
9733
9734dst_conn : integer
9735 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9736 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9737 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9738 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9739 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9740 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9741 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9742 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009744dst_port : integer
9745 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9746 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9747 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9748 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9749 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9750 an HTTP header.
9751
9752fe_id : integer
9753 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9754 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9755 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9756
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009757sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9758sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9759sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9760sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009761 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9762 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9763 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9764
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009765sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9766sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9767sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9768sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009769 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9770 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9771 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9772
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009773sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9774sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9775sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9776sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009777 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9778 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009779 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9780 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9781 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009782
9783 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9784 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009785 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9786 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9787 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009788 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9789 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9790
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009791sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9792sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9793sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9794sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009795 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9796 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9797
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009798sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9799sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9800sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9801sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009802 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9803 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9804 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9805
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009806sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9807sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9808sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9809sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009810 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9811 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9812 See also src_conn_rate.
9813
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009814sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9815sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9816sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9817sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009818 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009819 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009820
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009821sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9822sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9823sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9824sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009825 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9826 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9827 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009828 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9829 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9830 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009831
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009832sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9833sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9834sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9835sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009836 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9837 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9838 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9839
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009840sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9841sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9842sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9843sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009844 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9845 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9846 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9847 src_http_err_rate.
9848
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009849sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9850sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9851sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9852sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009853 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9854 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9855 src_http_req_cnt.
9856
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009857sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9858sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9859sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9860sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009861 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9862 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9863 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9864 src_http_req_rate.
9865
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009866sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9867sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9868sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9869sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009870 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009871 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9872 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9873 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9874 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009876 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9877 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009878 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9879
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009880sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9881sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9882sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9883sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009884 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9885 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9886 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9887 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9888
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009889sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9890sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9891sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9892sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009893 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9894 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9895 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9896 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9897
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009898sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9899sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9900sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9901sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009902 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9903 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9904 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9905 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009906 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009907 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9908
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009909sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9910sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9911sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9912sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009913 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9914 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9915 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9916 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9917 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009918 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009919
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009920sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9921sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9922sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9923sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009924 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9925 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9926 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9927
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009928sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9929sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9930sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9931sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009932 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9933 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009934 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009935 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9936 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009937 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9938 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9939 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009941so_id : integer
9942 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9943 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9944 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946src : ip
9947 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9948 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9949 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9950 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9951 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9952 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9953 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009954
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009955 Example:
9956 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9957 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009959src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9960 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9961 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9962 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009963 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009965src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9966 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9967 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009968 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009969 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009971src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9972 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9973 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9974 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9975 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9976 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9977 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009978
9979 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9980 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9981 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9982 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009983 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009984 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9985 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009987src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009988 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009989 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009990 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009991 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009993src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009994 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9996 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009997 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009999src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10000 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10001 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10002 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010003 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010005src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010006 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010007 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010008 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010009 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010011src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010012 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010014 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10015 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010016 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10017 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10018 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010020src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10021 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10022 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010023 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010024 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010025 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10028 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10029 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10030 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10031 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010032 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10035 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10036 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10037 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010038 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010040src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10041 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10042 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10043 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010044 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010045 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010047src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10048 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10049 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10050 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010051 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010052 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10053 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010054
10055 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010056 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010057 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010059src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10060 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10061 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10062 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10063 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010064 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10065 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010067src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10068 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10069 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010070 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10071 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010072 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010074src_port : integer
10075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10076 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10077 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10078 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010080src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10081 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010082 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10083 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10084 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010085 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010087src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10088 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10089 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10090 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10091 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010092 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010094src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10095 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10096 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10097 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10098 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10099 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10100 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10101 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10102 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010103
10104 Example :
10105 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10106 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10107 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10108 listen ssh
10109 bind :22
10110 mode tcp
10111 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010112 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010113 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010114 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010116srv_id : integer
10117 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10118 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10119 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010120
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101227.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
10123----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010125The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10126closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10127when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10128usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010129future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010131ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10132 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10133 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10134 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10135 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10136 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10139 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10140 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10141 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10142 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010144ssl_c_err : integer
10145 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10146 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10147 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10148 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10149 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10152 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10153 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10154 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10155 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10156 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10157 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10158 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10159 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161 ACL derivatives :
10162 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164ssl_c_key_alg : string
10165 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10166 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10167 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010169 ACL derivatives :
10170 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010172ssl_c_notafter : string
10173 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10174 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10175 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010177 ACL derivatives :
10178 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010180ssl_c_notbefore : string
10181 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10182 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10183 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010185 ACL derivatives :
10186 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010188ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10189 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10190 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10191 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10192 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10193 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10194 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10195 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10196 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010198 ACL derivatives :
10199 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010201ssl_c_serial : binary
10202 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10203 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10204 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206 ACL derivatives :
10207 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010209ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10210 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10211 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10212 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10215 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10216 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10217 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010219 ACL derivatives :
10220 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
10221
10222ssl_c_used : boolean
10223 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10224 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010226ssl_c_verify : integer
10227 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10228 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10229 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10230 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010232ssl_c_version : integer
10233 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10234 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10237 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10238 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10239 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10240 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010241 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010242 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10243 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10244 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010246 ACL derivatives :
10247 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010249ssl_f_key_alg : string
10250 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10251 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10252 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010254 ACL derivatives :
10255 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010257ssl_f_notafter : string
10258 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10259 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10260 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010262 ACL derivatives :
10263 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265ssl_f_notbefore : string
10266 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10267 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10268 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010270 ACL derivatives :
10271 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010273ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10274 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10275 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10276 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10277 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10278 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10279 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10280 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10281 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010283 ACL derivatives :
10284 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286ssl_f_serial : binary
10287 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10288 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10289 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010291 ACL derivatives :
10292 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010294ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10295 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10296 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10297 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010299 ACL derivatives :
10300 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010302ssl_f_version : integer
10303 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10304 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10305
10306ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010307 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10308 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10309 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010311 Example :
10312 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10313 listen http-https
10314 bind :80
10315 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10316 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10317
10318ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10319 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10320 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10321
10322ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010323 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010324 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10325 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10326 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10327 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10328 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10329 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10330 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10331 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10332
10333 ACL derivatives :
10334 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010336ssl_fc_cipher : string
10337 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10338 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010340 ACL derivatives :
10341 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010343ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010344 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10345 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010346 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10347 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10348 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10349 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010351ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10352 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010353 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10354 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10355 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10356 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010358ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010359 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010360 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10361 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10362 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10363 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10364 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10365 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10366 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368 ACL derivatives :
10369 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010371ssl_fc_protocol : string
10372 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10373 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010375 ACL derivatives :
10376 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10377
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010378ssl_fc_unique_id : string
10379 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10380 returns a base64 encoded string containing the TLS unique ID as defined
10381 in RFC5929 section 3.
10382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010383ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10384 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10385 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10386 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10387 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010389ssl_fc_sni : string
10390 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10391 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10392 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10393 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10394 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10395
10396 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10397 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10398 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010399 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10400 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010402 ACL derivatives :
10403 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10404 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10405 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010407ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10408 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10409 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010410
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104127.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10413------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010415Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10416sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10417only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10418For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10419be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10420can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10421sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10422for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10423content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010425payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10426 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10427 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10428 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010430payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10431 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10432 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10433 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010435req.len : integer
10436req_len : integer (deprecated)
10437 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10438 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10439 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10440 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10441 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10442 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10443 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10444 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010446req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10447 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010448 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10449 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10450 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10451 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010453 ACL alternatives :
10454 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010456req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10457 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10458 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10459 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10460 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010462 ACL alternatives :
10463 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010465 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010467req.proto_http : boolean
10468req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10469 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10470 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10471 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10472 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10473 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10474 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10475 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010477 Example:
10478 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10479 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10480 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010481 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010483req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10484rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10485 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10486 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10487 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10488 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10489 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10490 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10491 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010493 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10494 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10495 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10496 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10497 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10498 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010500 ACL derivatives :
10501 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010503 Example :
10504 listen tse-farm
10505 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10506 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10507 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10508 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10509 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10510 persist rdp-cookie
10511 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10512 # This is only useful makes sense if
10513 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10514 stick-table type string size 204800
10515 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10516 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10517 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010519 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10520 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010522req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10523rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10524 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10525 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10526 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10527 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010529 ACL derivatives :
10530 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010532req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10533req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10534 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10535 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10536 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10537 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10538 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10539 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10540 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542req.ssl_sni : string
10543req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10544 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10545 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10546 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10547 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10548 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10549 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10550 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10551 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10552 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10553 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10554 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10555 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557 ACL derivatives :
10558 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560 Examples :
10561 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10562 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10563 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10564 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10565 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10568rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10569 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10570 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10571 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10572 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10573 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10574 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10575 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577req.ssl_ver : integer
10578req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10579 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10580 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10581 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10582 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10583 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10584 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10585 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10586 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10587 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010589 ACL derivatives :
10590 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010591
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010592res.len : integer
10593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10594 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10595 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10596 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10597 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10598 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10599 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10600 content inspection.
10601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10603 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010604 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10605 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10606 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10607 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010609res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10610 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10611 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10612 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10613 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010615 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617wait_end : boolean
10618 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10619 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10620 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10621 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10622 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10623 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10624 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10625 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010627 Examples :
10628 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10629 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10630 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010632 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10633 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10634 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10635 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10636 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10637 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10638 tcp-request content reject
10639
10640
106417.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10642--------------------------------------
10643
10644It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10645This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10646data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10647its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10648HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10649content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10650to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10651more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10652response are indexed.
10653
10654base : string
10655 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10656 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10657 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10658 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10659 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10660 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10661 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10662 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10663
10664 ACL derivatives :
10665 base : exact string match
10666 base_beg : prefix match
10667 base_dir : subdir match
10668 base_dom : domain match
10669 base_end : suffix match
10670 base_len : length match
10671 base_reg : regex match
10672 base_sub : substring match
10673
10674base32 : integer
10675 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10676 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10677 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10678 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10679
10680base32+src : binary
10681 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10682 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10683 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10684 per-URL counters.
10685
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010686capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10687 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10688 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10689 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10690
10691capture.req.method : string
10692 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10693 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10694 because it's allocated.
10695
10696capture.req.uri : string
10697 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10698 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10699 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10700 allocated.
10701
10702capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10703 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10704 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10705 The first entry is an index of 0.
10706 See also: "capture response header"
10707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708req.cook([<name>]) : string
10709cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10710 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10711 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10712 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10713 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10714 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10715 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10716 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10717 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10718
10719 ACL derivatives :
10720 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10721 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10722 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10723 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10724 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10725 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10726 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10727 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10730cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10731 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10732 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010734req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10735cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10736 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10737 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10738 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10739 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010741cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10742 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10743 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10744 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10745 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10746 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10747 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10748 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10749 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10750 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10751 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10754 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10755 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10756 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10757 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010758 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010760req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10761 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10762 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10763 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10764 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10765 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10766 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10767 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10768 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010770req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10771 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10772 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10773 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10774 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010776req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10777 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10778 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10779 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10780 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10781 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10782 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10783 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10784 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10785 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10786 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10787 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010789 ACL derivatives :
10790 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10791 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10792 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10793 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10794 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10795 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10796 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10797 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10798
10799req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10800hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10801 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10802 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10803 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10804 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10805 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10806 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10807 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10808 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10809 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10810
10811req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10812hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10813 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10814 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10815 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10816 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10817 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10818 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10819 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10820 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10821
10822req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10823hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10824 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10825 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10826 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10827 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10828 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10829 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10830 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10831
10832http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10833 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10834 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10835 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10836 basic auth is supported.
10837
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010838http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
10839 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
10840 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
10841 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
10842 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010843 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10844 basic auth is supported.
10845
10846 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010847 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
10848 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
10849 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
10850 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851
10852http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010853 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10854 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010855 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10856 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010858method : integer + string
10859 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10860 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10861 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10862 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10863 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10864 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10865 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010867 ACL derivatives :
10868 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010870 Example :
10871 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10872 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10873 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010875path : string
10876 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10877 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10878 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10879 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10880 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10881 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10882 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010884 ACL derivatives :
10885 path : exact string match
10886 path_beg : prefix match
10887 path_dir : subdir match
10888 path_dom : domain match
10889 path_end : suffix match
10890 path_len : length match
10891 path_reg : regex match
10892 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010894req.ver : string
10895req_ver : string (deprecated)
10896 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10897 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10898 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010900 ACL derivatives :
10901 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010903res.comp : boolean
10904 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10905 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10906 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010908res.comp_algo : string
10909 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10910 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10911 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913res.cook([<name>]) : string
10914scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10915 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10916 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10917 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919 ACL derivatives :
10920 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10923scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10924 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10925 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10926 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10929scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10930 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10931 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10932 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010934res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10935 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10936 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10937 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10938 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10939 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10940 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10941 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10942 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10943 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010945res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10946 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10947 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10948 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10949 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10950 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010952res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10953shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10954 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10955 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10956 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10957 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10958 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10959 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10960 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10961 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010963 ACL derivatives :
10964 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10965 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10966 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10967 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10968 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10969 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10970 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10971 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10972
10973res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10974shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10975 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10976 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10977 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10978 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10979 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010981res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10982shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10983 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10984 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10985 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10986 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10987 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10988 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010990res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10991shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10992 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10993 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10994 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10995 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10996 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10997 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010999res.ver : string
11000resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11001 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11002 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004 ACL derivatives :
11005 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011007set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11008 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11009 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11010 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11011 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011013 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11014 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011016 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018status : integer
11019 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11020 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11021 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023url : string
11024 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11025 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11026 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11027 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11028 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11029 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11030 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011032 ACL derivatives :
11033 url : exact string match
11034 url_beg : prefix match
11035 url_dir : subdir match
11036 url_dom : domain match
11037 url_end : suffix match
11038 url_len : length match
11039 url_reg : regex match
11040 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011042url_ip : ip
11043 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11044 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11045 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11046 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11047 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11048 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11049 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011051url_port : integer
11052 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11053 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11054 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11055 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11058url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11059 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11060 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11061 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11062 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11063 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11064 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11065 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11066 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11067 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069 ACL derivatives :
11070 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11071 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11072 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11073 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11074 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11075 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11076 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11077 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011078
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080 Example :
11081 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11082 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11083 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11084 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011086urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11087 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11088 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11089 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011090
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200110927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011093---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011095Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11096every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011097order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011099ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11100---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011101FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011102HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011103HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11104HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011105HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11106HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11107HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11108HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11109LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011110METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11111METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11112METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11113METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11114METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11115METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011116RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011117REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011118TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011119WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11120---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011121
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111238. Logging
11124----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011125
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011126One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11127provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11128very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11129provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11130state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011131to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011132headers.
11133
11134In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11135about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11136send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11137
11138 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11139 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11140 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11141 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11142 at the termination.
11143
11144The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11145allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11146as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11147while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11148real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11149delay.
11150
11151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111528.1. Log levels
11153---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011154
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011155TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011156source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011157HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11158in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11159track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11160syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11161about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011162
11163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111648.2. Log formats
11165----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011166
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011167HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011168and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11169slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11170options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011171
11172 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11173 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11174 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11175 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11176 extents.
11177
11178 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11179 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11180 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11181 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11182 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11183
11184 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11185 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11186 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11187 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11188 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11189
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011190 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11191 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11192 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11193 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11194
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011195 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11196
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011197Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11198specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11199field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11200servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11201always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11202identifier.
11203
11204Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11205 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11206 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11207 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11208 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11209
11210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112118.2.1. Default log format
11212-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011213
11214This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11215as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11216format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11217
11218 Example :
11219 listen www
11220 mode http
11221 log global
11222 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11223
11224 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11225 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11226 (www/HTTP)
11227
11228 Field Format Extract from the example above
11229 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11230 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11231 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11232 4 'to' to
11233 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11234 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11235
11236Detailed fields description :
11237 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11238 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11239 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11240 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11241 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11242 and processed the connection.
11243 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11244
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011245In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11246"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11247connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11248
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011249It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11250will eventually disappear.
11251
11252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112538.2.2. TCP log format
11254---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011255
11256The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11257is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11258information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11259counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11260emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11261environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11262the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11263sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011264specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11265not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11266fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11267marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011268
11269 Example :
11270 frontend fnt
11271 mode tcp
11272 option tcplog
11273 log global
11274 default_backend bck
11275
11276 backend bck
11277 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11278
11279 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11280 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11281 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11282
11283 Field Format Extract from the example above
11284 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11285 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11286 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11287 4 frontend_name fnt
11288 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11289 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11290 7 bytes_read* 212
11291 8 termination_state --
11292 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11293 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11294
11295Detailed fields description :
11296 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011297 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11298 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11299 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11300 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11301 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011302
11303 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011304 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11305 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11306 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011307
11308 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11309 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11310 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11311 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11312
11313 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11314 and processed the connection.
11315
11316 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11317 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11318 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11319 applications.
11320
11321 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11322 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11323 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11324 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11325 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11326
11327 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11328 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11329 See "Timers" below for more details.
11330
11331 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11332 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11333 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11334 "Timers" below for more details.
11335
11336 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011337 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011338 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11339 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11340 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11341 details.
11342
11343 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11344 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11345 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11346 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11347 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11348
11349 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11350 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11351 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11352 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11353 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11354 for more details.
11355
11356 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011357 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011358 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11359 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11360 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011361 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011362
11363 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11364 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11365 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11366 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11367 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11368 caused by a denial of service attack.
11369
11370 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11371 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11372 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11373 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11374 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11375 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11376 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11377 denial of service attack.
11378
11379 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11380 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11381 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11382 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11383 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11384 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11385 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11386 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11387 be processed than on other servers.
11388
11389 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11390 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11391 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11392 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11393 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11394 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11395 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11396 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11397 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11398 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11399 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11400 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11401 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11402
11403 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11404 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11405 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11406 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11407 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11408 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11409 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11410 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11411
11412 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11413 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11414 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11415 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11416 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11417 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11418 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11419 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11420 occurs.
11421
11422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114238.2.3. HTTP log format
11424----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011425
11426The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11427is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11428the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11429are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11430emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11431generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11432"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11433which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011434frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11435is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011436
11437Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11438slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11439with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11440
11441 Example :
11442 frontend http-in
11443 mode http
11444 option httplog
11445 log global
11446 default_backend bck
11447
11448 backend static
11449 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11450
11451 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11452 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11453 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011454 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011455
11456 Field Format Extract from the example above
11457 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11458 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11459 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11460 4 frontend_name http-in
11461 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11462 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11463 7 status_code 200
11464 8 bytes_read* 2750
11465 9 captured_request_cookie -
11466 10 captured_response_cookie -
11467 11 termination_state ----
11468 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11469 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11470 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11471 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11472 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011473
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011474
11475Detailed fields description :
11476 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011477 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11478 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11479 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11480 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11481 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011482
11483 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011484 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11485 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11486 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011487
11488 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11489 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11490 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11491 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11492 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11493
11494 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11495 and processed the connection.
11496
11497 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11498 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11499 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11500
11501 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11502 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11503 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11504 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11505 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11506 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11507
11508 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11509 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11510 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11511 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11512 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11513 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11514
11515 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11516 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11517 See "Timers" below for more details.
11518
11519 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11520 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11521 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11522 below for more details.
11523
11524 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11525 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11526 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11527 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11528 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11529 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11530 for more details.
11531
11532 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011533 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011534 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11535 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11536 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11537 details.
11538
11539 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11540 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11541 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11542
11543 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11544 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11545 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11546 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11547 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11548 overflowing.
11549
11550 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11551 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11552 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11553 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11554 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11555 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11556 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11557 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11558
11559 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11560 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11561 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11562 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11563 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11564 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11565 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11566 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11567
11568 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11569 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11570 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11571 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11572 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11573 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11574 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11575
11576 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011577 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011578 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11579 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11580 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011581 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011582 system.
11583
11584 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11585 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11586 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11587 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11588 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11589 caused by a denial of service attack.
11590
11591 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11592 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11593 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11594 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11595 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11596 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11597 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11598 denial of service attack.
11599
11600 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11601 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11602 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11603 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11604 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11605 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11606 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11607 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11608 processed than on other servers.
11609
11610 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11611 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11612 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11613 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11614 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11615 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11616 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11617 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11618 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11619 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11620 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11621 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11622 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11623
11624 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11625 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11626 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11627 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11628 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11629 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11630 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11631 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11632
11633 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11634 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11635 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11636 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11637 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11638 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11639 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11640 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11641 occurs.
11642
11643 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11644 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11645 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11646 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11647 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11648 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11649 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11650 cookies" below for more details.
11651
11652 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11653 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11654 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11655 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11656 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11657 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11658 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11659 and cookies" below for more details.
11660
11661 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11662 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11663 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11664 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11665 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11666 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11667 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11668 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11669
11670
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200116718.2.4. Custom log format
11672------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011673
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011674The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011675mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011676
11677HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11678Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11679separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11680prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11681
11682Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11683variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11684string formats ("Q").
11685
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011686If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011687as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011688less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11689the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11690
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011691Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011692In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011693in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011694
11695Flags are :
11696 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011697 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011698
11699 Example:
11700
11701 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11702 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11703
11704At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11705
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011706 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11707 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011708
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011709the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011710
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011711 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011712 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011713 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011714
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011715and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11716
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011717 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011718 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11719
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011720Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11721
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011722 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011723 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011724 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11725 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11726 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011727 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11728 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11729 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011730 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011731 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011732 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011733 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011734 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011735 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011736 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11737 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011738 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011739 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11740 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011741 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011742 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11743 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011744 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11745 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11746 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011747 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011748 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11749 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011750 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011751 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11752 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11753 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011754 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011755 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11756 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11757 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11758 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011759 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011760 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011761 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011762 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011763 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011764 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011765 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11766 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11767 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011768 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011769 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11770 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011771 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011772 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011773 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011774 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011775
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011776 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011777
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011778
117798.2.5. Error log format
11780-----------------------
11781
11782When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11783protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11784By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11785"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11786will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11787logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11788
11789The format looks like this :
11790
11791 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11792 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11793 Connection error during SSL handshake
11794
11795 Field Format Extract from the example above
11796 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11797 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11798 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11799 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11800 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11801
11802These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11803failures.
11804
11805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118068.3. Advanced logging options
11807-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011808
11809Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11810just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11811options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11812for more information about their usage.
11813
11814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118158.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11816------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011817
11818It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11819haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11820commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11821monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11822ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11823
11824 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11825 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11826 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11827 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11828
11829 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11830 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11831 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011832 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011833 such as other load-balancers.
11834
11835 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11836 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11837 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11838
11839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118408.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11841----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011842
11843The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11844what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11845or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11846"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11847just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11848log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11849after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11850is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11851with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11852with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11853
11854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118558.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11856------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011857
11858Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11859for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11860"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11861retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11862raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11863a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11864file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11865you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11866"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11867
11868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118698.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11870--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011871
11872Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11873multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11874them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11875"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11876logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11877error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11878and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11879too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11880useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11881alternative.
11882
11883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118848.4. Timing events
11885------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011886
11887Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11888reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11889the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11890frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11891mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11892
11893 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11894 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11895 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11896 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11897 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11898
11899 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11900 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11901 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11902 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11903 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11904
11905 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11906 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11907 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11908 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11909 connection never established.
11910
11911 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11912 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11913 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11914 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11915 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11916 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11917 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11918 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11919 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11920 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11921 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11922
11923 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11924 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11925 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11926 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011927 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011928
11929 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11930
11931 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11932 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11933 negative.
11934
11935These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11936protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11937that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011938due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011939close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11940session has been aborted on timeout.
11941
11942Most common cases :
11943
11944 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11945 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11946 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11947 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11948 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11949 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11950 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11951 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11952 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011953 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11954 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11955 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011956
11957 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11958 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11959 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11960 of ms on remote networks.
11961
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011962 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11963 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11964 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011965
11966 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11967 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11968 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11969 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11970 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11971 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11972 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11973 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11974 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11975 to the server until another one is released.
11976
11977Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11978
11979 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11980 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11981 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11982
11983 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11984 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11985 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11986
11987 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11988 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11989 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11990 flags.
11991
11992 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11993 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11994 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11995 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11996 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11997 the client connection was maintained open.
11998
11999 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012000 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012001 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12002 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12003
12004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120058.5. Session state at disconnection
12006-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012007
12008TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12009"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
120102-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12011each of which has a special meaning :
12012
12013 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12014 session to terminate :
12015
12016 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12017
12018 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12019 server explicitly refused it.
12020
12021 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12022 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12023 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12024 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012025 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12026
12027 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12028 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012029
12030 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12031 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12032 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12033 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12034 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12035
12036 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12037 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12038 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12039 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12040 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12041
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012042 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12043 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12044
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012045 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12046 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12047 backup connections when going up.
12048
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012049 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12050
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012051 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12052 send or receive data.
12053
12054 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12055 send or receive data.
12056
12057 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12058 with nothing left in the buffers.
12059
12060 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12061
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012062 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012063 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12064
12065 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12066 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12067 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12068 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12069 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12070
12071 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12072 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12073
12074 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12075 server (HTTP only).
12076
12077 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12078
12079 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12080 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12081 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12082
12083 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12084 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12085 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12086
12087 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12088
12089 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12090 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12091
12092 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12093 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12094 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12095
12096 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12097 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012098 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12099 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012100
12101 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12102 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12103 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12104 another server.
12105
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012106 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012107 server.
12108
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012109 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12110 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12111 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12112 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12113
12114 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12115 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12116 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12117 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12118
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012119 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12120 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12121 "use-server" rule).
12122
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012123 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12124
12125 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12126 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12127
12128 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12129
12130 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12131 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12132 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12133
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012134 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12135 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012136 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012137 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12138 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12139
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012140 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12141
12142 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12143 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12144
12145 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12146
12147 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12148
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012149The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12150was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012151helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12152starvation, attacks, etc...
12153
12154The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12155alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12156easier finding and understanding.
12157
12158 Flags Reason
12159
12160 -- Normal termination.
12161
12162 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12163 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12164 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12165 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12166
12167 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12168 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12169 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12170 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12171 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12172 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012173
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012174 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12175 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012176 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012177
12178 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12179 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12180 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12181
12182 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12183 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12184 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12185 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12186 the server takes too long to respond.
12187
12188 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12189 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12190 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12191 long a time to respond.
12192
12193 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12194 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12195 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12196 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12197 and the client.
12198
12199 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12200 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12201 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12202 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12203 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12204 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12205
12206 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12207 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012208 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12209 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12210 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12211 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012212
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012213 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12214 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012216 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012217 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12218 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12219 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12220 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12221 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12222
12223 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12224 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12225 503 or 504 here.
12226
12227 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12228 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12229 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12230 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12231 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12232
12233 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12234 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012235 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012236 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12237 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12238
12239 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12240 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12241 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12242 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12243 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12244 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12245 between haproxy and the server.
12246
12247 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12248 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12249 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12250 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12251 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12252 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12253 solution is to fix the application.
12254
12255 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12256 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12257 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12258 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12259 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12260 external attacks.
12261
12262 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12263 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012264 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012265 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12266 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12267
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012268 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12269 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12270 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012271 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12272 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012273
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012274 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12275 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12276 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12277 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012278 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12279 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12280 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12281 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12282 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012283
12284 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12285 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12286 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12287 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12288
12289 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12290 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12291 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12292 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12293
12294 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12295 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12296 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12297 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012299The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12300persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12301important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12302re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12303
12304 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12305
12306 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12307 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12308 set on a GET request.
12309
12310 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12311 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012312 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012313 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12314
12315 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12316 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12317 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12318
12319 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12320 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12321 already got a cookie.
12322
12323 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12324 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12325 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12326 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12327 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12328
12329 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12330 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12331 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12332
12333 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12334 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12335 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12336
12337 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12338 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12339
12340 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12341 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12342 then advertised in the response.
12343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123458.6. Non-printable characters
12346-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012347
12348In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12349consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12350converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12351prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12352being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12353escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12354is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12355'}' when logging headers.
12356
12357Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12358issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12359containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12360
12361Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12362the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12363performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12364
12365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123668.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12367---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012368
12369Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12370achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012371section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012372cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12373the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12374the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012375locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012376not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12377user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12378a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12379wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12380
12381 Examples :
12382 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12383 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12384
12385 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12386 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12387
12388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12390---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012391
12392Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12393proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12394the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12395server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12396
12397Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12398response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012399section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012400
12401It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012402time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12403appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012404are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12405and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12406follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12407request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12408in the logs.
12409
12410 Example :
12411 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12412 listen proxy-out
12413 mode http
12414 option httplog
12415 option logasap
12416 log global
12417 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12418
12419 # log the name of the virtual server
12420 capture request header Host len 20
12421
12422 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12423 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12424
12425 # log the beginning of the referrer
12426 capture request header Referer len 20
12427
12428 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12429 capture response header Server len 20
12430
12431 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12432 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12433
12434 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12435 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12436
12437 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12438 capture response header Via len 20
12439
12440 # log the URL location during a redirection
12441 capture response header Location len 20
12442
12443 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12444 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12445 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12446 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12447 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12448
12449 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12450 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12451 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12452 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012453 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012454
12455 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12456 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12457 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12458 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12459 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012460 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012461
12462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124638.9. Examples of logs
12464---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012465
12466These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12467them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12468reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12469
12470 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12471 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12472 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12473
12474 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12475 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12476
12477 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12478 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12479 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12480
12481 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12482 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12483
12484 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12485 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12486 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12487
12488 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012489 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012490 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12491 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12492
12493 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12494 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12495 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12496
12497 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12498 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012499 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012500 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12501 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12502 to return the 502 and not the server.
12503
12504 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012505 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012506
12507 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12508 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12509 Nothing was sent to any server.
12510
12511 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12512 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12513
12514 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12515 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12516 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12517 send a 408 return code to the client.
12518
12519 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12520 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12521
12522 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12523 5 seconds ("c----").
12524
12525 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12526 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012527 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012528
12529 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012530 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012531 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12532 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12533 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12534 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12535 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012536
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125389. Statistics and monitoring
12539----------------------------
12540
12541It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12542mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12543CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12544Unix socket.
12545
12546
125479.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012548---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012549
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012550The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12551page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012553 0. pxname: proxy name
12554 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12555 for server)
12556 2. qcur: current queued requests
12557 3. qmax: max queued requests
12558 4. scur: current sessions
12559 5. smax: max sessions
12560 6. slim: sessions limit
12561 7. stot: total sessions
12562 8. bin: bytes in
12563 9. bout: bytes out
12564 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012565 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012566 12. ereq: request errors
12567 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012568 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012569 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12570 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012571 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012572 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12573 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12574 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12575 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12576 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12577 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12578 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12579 25. qlimit: queue limit
12580 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12581 27. iid: unique proxy id
12582 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12583 29. throttle: warm up status
12584 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12585 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012586 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012587 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12588 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12589 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012590 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012591 UNK -> unknown
12592 INI -> initializing
12593 SOCKERR -> socket error
12594 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12595 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12596 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12597 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12598 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12599 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12600 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12601 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12602 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12603 disable-on-404
12604 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12605 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12606 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012607 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12608 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012609 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12610 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12611 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12612 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12613 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12614 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012615 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12616 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12617 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12618 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012619 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12620 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012621 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12622 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12623 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012624 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012625 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012626
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126289.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012629-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012630
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012631The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12632necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12633A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12634issuing commands by hand :
12635
12636 global
12637 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12638 stats timeout 2m
12639
12640It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12641the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12642never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12643situations :
12644
12645 global
12646 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12647 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12648 stats timeout 2m
12649
12650To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12651swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12652to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12653syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12654
12655 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12656 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12657
12658The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12659script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12660for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12661
12662The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12663that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12664editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12665(eg: watch a counter).
12666
12667The socket supports two operation modes :
12668 - interactive
12669 - non-interactive
12670
12671The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12672this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12673sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12674mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12675commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12676example :
12677
12678 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12679
12680The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12681entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12682for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12683sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12684"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12685after processing the last command of the same line.
12686
12687For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12688"prompt" command :
12689
12690 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12691 prompt
12692 > show info
12693 ...
12694 >
12695
12696Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12697delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12698that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12699parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012700
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012701It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12702on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12703own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012704
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012705The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12706If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12707all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12708it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12709
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012710add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012711 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12712 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12713 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12714 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012715
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012716add map <map> <key> <value>
12717 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12718 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012719 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12720 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12721 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012722
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012723clear counters
12724 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12725 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12726 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12727 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12728 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12729
12730clear counters all
12731 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12732 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12733 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12734
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012735clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012736 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12737 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12738 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012739
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012740clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012741 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12742 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12743 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012744
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012745clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12746 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12747
12748 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12749 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12750 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12751 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12752 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12753 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12754
12755 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12756
12757 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12758 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12759 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12760 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12761 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12762 the ACLs :
12763
12764 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12765 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12766 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12767 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12768 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12769 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12770
12771 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012772 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12773 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012774
12775 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012776 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012777 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012778 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12779 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12780 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12781 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012782
12783 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12784
12785 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012786 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012787 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12788 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012789 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12790 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12791 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012792
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012793del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
12794 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012795 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
12796 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12797 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
12798 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012799
12800del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012801 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012802 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
12803 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12804 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
12805 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012806
12807disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012808 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12809
12810 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12811 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12812 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12813 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12814 re-enabled using enable agent.
12815
12816 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12817 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12818 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12819 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12820 otherwise unchanged.
12821
12822 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12823 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12824 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12825
12826 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12827 level "admin".
12828
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012829disable frontend <frontend>
12830 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12831 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12832 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12833 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12834 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12835 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12836 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12837 on the stats page.
12838
12839 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12840 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12841
12842 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12843 level "admin".
12844
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012845disable server <backend>/<server>
12846 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12847 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12848 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12849 during the maintenance.
12850
12851 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12852 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12853
12854 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012855 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012856
12857 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12858 level "admin".
12859
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012860enable agent <backend>/<server>
12861 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12862
12863 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12864 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12865
12866 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12867 level "admin".
12868
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012869enable frontend <frontend>
12870 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12871 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12872 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12873 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12874 which was disabled.
12875
12876 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12877 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12878
12879 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12880 level "admin".
12881
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012882enable server <backend>/<server>
12883 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12884 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12885
12886 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012887 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012888
12889 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12890 level "admin".
12891
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012892get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012893get acl <acl> <value>
12894 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
12895 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
12896 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
12897 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
12898 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012899
12900 The first two words are:
12901
12902 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
12903 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
12904 "dom", "end" or "reg".
12905
12906 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
12907
12908 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
12909
12910 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
12911
12912 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
12913 interpretation of the case.
12914
12915 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
12916 useful with regular expressions.
12917
12918 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
12919 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
12920
12921 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
12922 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
12923 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
12924
12925 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
12926
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012927get weight <backend>/<server>
12928 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12929 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12930 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12931 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12932 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012933 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012934
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012935help
12936 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12937 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012938
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012939prompt
12940 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12941 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12942 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12943 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12944 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12945 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12946 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12947 command.
12948
12949quit
12950 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012951
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012952set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012953 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
12954 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
12955 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012956
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012957set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012958 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12959 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12960 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12961 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12962 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012963 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12964 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12965
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012966set maxconn global <maxconn>
12967 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12968 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12969 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12970 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12971 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12972 setting.
12973
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012974set rate-limit connections global <value>
12975 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12976 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12977 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12978 is passed in number of connections per second.
12979
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012980set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12981 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12982 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012983 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12984 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012985
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012986set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12987 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12988 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12989 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12990 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12991
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012992set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12993 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12994 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12995 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12996 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12997 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12998
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012999set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013000 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13001 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13002 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13003 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013004 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13005 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013007set timeout cli <delay>
13008 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13009 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13010 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13011
13012set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13013 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13014 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013015 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13016 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13017 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13018 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13019 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13020 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13021 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13022 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13023 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13024 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13025 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13026 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13027 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013028
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013029show errors [<iid>]
13030 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13031 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013032 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13033 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13034 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013035
13036 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13037 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13038 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13039 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13040 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13041 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13042 are reported too.
13043
13044 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13045 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13046 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13047 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13048 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13049 code.
13050
13051 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13052 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13053 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13054 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13055 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13056 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13057 line.
13058
13059 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013060 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13061 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013062 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13063 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13064
13065 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13066 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13067 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13068 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13069 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13070 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13071 00204+ minal\r\n
13072 00211 \r\n
13073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013074 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013075 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13076 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13077 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13078 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13079 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13080 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013081
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013082show info
13083 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13084
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013085show map [<map>]
13086 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013087 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13088 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13089 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13090 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13091 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13092 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013093
13094show acl [<acl>]
13095 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013096 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13097 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13098 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13099 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13100 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013101
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013102show pools
13103 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13104 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13105 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13106 the pools.
13107
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013108show sess
13109 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013110 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13111 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13112
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013113show sess <id>
13114 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13115 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13116 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13117 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13118 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013119 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13120 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13121 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013122
13123show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13124 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13125 possible to dump only selected items :
13126 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13127 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13128 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13129 for example:
13130 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13131 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13132 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13133
13134 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013135 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13136 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013137 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13138 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13139 Nbproc: 1
13140 Process_num: 1
13141 (...)
13142
13143 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13144 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13145 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13146 (...)
13147 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13148
13149 $
13150
13151 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13152 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13153 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13154 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013155 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013156
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013157show table
13158 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13159 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13160 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13161 entries currently in use.
13162
13163 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013164 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013165 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13166 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013167
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013168show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013169 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13170 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13171 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013172 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13173
13174 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13175 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13176 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13177 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13178 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13179
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013180 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13181 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13182 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13183 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13184 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13185 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13186
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013187
13188 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013189 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13190 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013192 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013193 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013194 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013195 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13196 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13197 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13198 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013199
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013200 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013201 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013202 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13203 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013204
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013205 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13206 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013207 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013208 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13209 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013210
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013211 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13212 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013213 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013214 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13215 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13216
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013217 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13218 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13219 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13220 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13221 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13222
13223 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13224 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13225 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013226 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13227 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013228 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13229 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013230
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013231shutdown frontend <frontend>
13232 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13233 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13234 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13235 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13236 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13237 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13238 once it is terminated.
13239
13240 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13241 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13242
13243 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13244 level "admin".
13245
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013246shutdown session <id>
13247 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13248 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13249 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13250 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13251 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13252 flag in the logs.
13253
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013254shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13255 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13256 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13257 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13258 'K' flag in the logs.
13259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013260/*
13261 * Local variables:
13262 * fill-column: 79
13263 * End:
13264 */